blob: 3212c36b9ab092634edbbaa37860a528d03b2ad8 [file] [log] [blame]
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001//===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
5// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000017#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000018#include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000019#include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000020#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000021#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +000022#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000023#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000024#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +000026#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Douglas Gregor2bbc0262010-09-12 04:28:07 +000029#include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
Douglas Gregor58e008d2008-11-13 20:12:29 +000030#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Douglas Gregor55297ac2008-12-23 00:26:44 +000031#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000032#include <algorithm>
33
34namespace clang {
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +000035using namespace sema;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000036
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000037/// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38/// function.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000039static ExprResult
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000040CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn,
41 SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation()) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +000042 ExprResult E = S.Owned(new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc));
43 E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
44 if (E.isInvalid())
45 return ExprError();
46 return move(E);
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +000047}
48
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000049static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
50 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +000051 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
52 bool CStyle);
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +000053
54static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
55 QualType &ToType,
56 bool InOverloadResolution,
57 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
58 bool CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +000059static OverloadingResult
60IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
61 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
62 OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
63 bool AllowExplicit);
64
65
66static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
67CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
68 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
69 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
70
71static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
72CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
73 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
74 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
75
76static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
77CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
78 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
79 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
80
81
82
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000083/// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
84/// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000085ImplicitConversionCategory
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000086GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
87 static const ImplicitConversionCategory
88 Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
89 ICC_Identity,
90 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
91 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
92 ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +000093 ICC_Identity,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +000094 ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
95 ICC_Promotion,
96 ICC_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +000097 ICC_Promotion,
98 ICC_Conversion,
99 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000100 ICC_Conversion,
101 ICC_Conversion,
102 ICC_Conversion,
103 ICC_Conversion,
104 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000105 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000106 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000107 ICC_Conversion,
108 ICC_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000109 ICC_Conversion
110 };
111 return Category[(int)Kind];
112}
113
114/// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
115/// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
116ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
117 static const ImplicitConversionRank
118 Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
119 ICR_Exact_Match,
120 ICR_Exact_Match,
121 ICR_Exact_Match,
122 ICR_Exact_Match,
123 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000124 ICR_Exact_Match,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000125 ICR_Promotion,
126 ICR_Promotion,
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000127 ICR_Promotion,
128 ICR_Conversion,
129 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000130 ICR_Conversion,
131 ICR_Conversion,
132 ICR_Conversion,
133 ICR_Conversion,
134 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000135 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000136 ICR_Conversion,
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000137 ICR_Conversion,
138 ICR_Conversion,
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000139 ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
140 ICR_Conversion,
141 ICR_Conversion
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000142 };
143 return Rank[(int)Kind];
144}
145
146/// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
147/// implicit conversion.
148const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
Nuno Lopescfca1f02009-12-23 17:49:57 +0000149 static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000150 "No conversion",
151 "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
152 "Array-to-pointer",
153 "Function-to-pointer",
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000154 "Noreturn adjustment",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000155 "Qualification",
156 "Integral promotion",
157 "Floating point promotion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000158 "Complex promotion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000159 "Integral conversion",
160 "Floating conversion",
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +0000161 "Complex conversion",
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000162 "Floating-integral conversion",
163 "Pointer conversion",
164 "Pointer-to-member conversion",
Douglas Gregor786ab212008-10-29 02:00:59 +0000165 "Boolean conversion",
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +0000166 "Compatible-types conversion",
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000167 "Derived-to-base conversion",
168 "Vector conversion",
169 "Vector splat",
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +0000170 "Complex-real conversion",
171 "Block Pointer conversion",
172 "Transparent Union Conversion"
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000173 };
174 return Name[Kind];
175}
176
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000177/// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
178/// sequence to the identity conversion.
179void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
180 First = ICK_Identity;
181 Second = ICK_Identity;
182 Third = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +0000183 DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000184 ReferenceBinding = false;
185 DirectBinding = false;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +0000186 IsLvalueReference = true;
187 BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
188 BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +0000189 BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000190 CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000191}
192
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000193/// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
194/// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
195/// implicit conversions.
196ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
197 ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
198 if (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
199 Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
200 if (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
201 Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
202 if (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
203 Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
204 return Rank;
205}
206
207/// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
208/// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000209/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000210/// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000211bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000212 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
213 // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
214 // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
215 // a pointer.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000216 if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
John McCall6d1116a2010-06-11 10:04:22 +0000217 (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
218 getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
219 getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
Anders Carlsson7da7cc52010-11-05 00:12:09 +0000220 getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000221 First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
222 return true;
223
224 return false;
225}
226
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000227/// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
228/// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
229/// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
230/// 13.3.3.2p4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000231bool
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000232StandardConversionSequence::
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000233isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000234 QualType FromType = getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000235 QualType ToType = getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000236
237 // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
238 // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
239 // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
240 if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
241 FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
242
John McCall75851b12010-10-26 06:40:27 +0000243 if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000244 if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +0000245 return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
246
247 return false;
248}
249
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000250/// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
251/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
252void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000253 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000254 bool PrintedSomething = false;
255 if (First != ICK_Identity) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000256 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000257 PrintedSomething = true;
258 }
259
260 if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
261 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000262 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000263 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000264 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000265
266 if (CopyConstructor) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000267 OS << " (by copy constructor)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000268 } else if (DirectBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000269 OS << " (direct reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000270 } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000271 OS << " (reference binding)";
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000272 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000273 PrintedSomething = true;
274 }
275
276 if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
277 if (PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000278 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000279 }
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000280 OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000281 PrintedSomething = true;
282 }
283
284 if (!PrintedSomething) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000285 OS << "No conversions required";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000286 }
287}
288
289/// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
290/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
291void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000292 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000293 if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
294 Before.DebugPrint();
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000295 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000296 }
Benjamin Kramerb11416d2010-04-17 09:33:03 +0000297 OS << '\'' << ConversionFunction << '\'';
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000298 if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000299 OS << " -> ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000300 After.DebugPrint();
301 }
302}
303
304/// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
305/// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
306void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000307 llvm::raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000308 switch (ConversionKind) {
309 case StandardConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000310 OS << "Standard conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000311 Standard.DebugPrint();
312 break;
313 case UserDefinedConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000314 OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000315 UserDefined.DebugPrint();
316 break;
317 case EllipsisConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000318 OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000319 break;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000320 case AmbiguousConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000321 OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000322 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000323 case BadConversion:
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000324 OS << "Bad conversion";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000325 break;
326 }
327
Daniel Dunbar42e3df02010-01-22 02:04:41 +0000328 OS << "\n";
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000329}
330
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000331void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
332 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
333}
334
335void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
336 conversions().~ConversionSet();
337}
338
339void
340AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
341 FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
342 ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
343 new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
344}
345
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000346namespace {
347 // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
348 // template parameter and template argument information.
349 struct DFIParamWithArguments {
350 TemplateParameter Param;
351 TemplateArgument FirstArg;
352 TemplateArgument SecondArg;
353 };
354}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000355
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000356/// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
357/// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
358OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000359static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
360 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
John McCall19c1bfd2010-08-25 05:32:35 +0000361 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000362 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
363 Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
364 Result.Data = 0;
365 switch (TDK) {
366 case Sema::TDK_Success:
367 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000368 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
369 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000370 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000371
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000372 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000373 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000374 Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
375 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000376
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000377 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000378 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +0000379 // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
380 DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000381 Saved->Param = Info.Param;
382 Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
383 Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
384 Result.Data = Saved;
385 break;
386 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000387
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000388 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000389 Result.Data = Info.take();
390 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000391
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000392 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000393 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000394 break;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000395 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000396
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000397 return Result;
398}
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000399
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000400void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
401 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
402 case Sema::TDK_Success:
403 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
404 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000405 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
406 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000407 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000408 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000409
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000410 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000411 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregorb02d6b32010-05-08 20:20:05 +0000412 // FIXME: Destroy the data?
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000413 Data = 0;
414 break;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000415
416 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
417 // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
418 Data = 0;
419 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000420
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000421 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000422 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000423 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
424 break;
425 }
426}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000427
428TemplateParameter
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000429OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
430 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
431 case Sema::TDK_Success:
432 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000433 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
434 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000435 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000436 return TemplateParameter();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000437
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000438 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000439 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000440 return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000441
442 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000443 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000444 return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000445
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000446 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000447 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000448 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
449 break;
450 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000451
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000452 return TemplateParameter();
453}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000454
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000455TemplateArgumentList *
456OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
457 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
458 case Sema::TDK_Success:
459 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
460 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
461 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
462 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
463 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
464 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000465 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000466 return 0;
467
468 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
469 return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000470
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000471 // Unhandled
472 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
473 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
474 break;
475 }
476
477 return 0;
478}
479
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000480const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
481 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
482 case Sema::TDK_Success:
483 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
484 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000485 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
486 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000487 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000488 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000489 return 0;
490
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000491 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000492 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000493 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000494
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000495 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000496 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000497 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
498 break;
499 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000500
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000501 return 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000502}
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000503
504const TemplateArgument *
505OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
506 switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
507 case Sema::TDK_Success:
508 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
509 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000510 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
511 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +0000512 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +0000513 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000514 return 0;
515
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000516 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +0000517 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000518 return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
519
Douglas Gregor461761d2010-05-08 18:20:53 +0000520 // Unhandled
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000521 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000522 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
523 break;
524 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000525
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000526 return 0;
527}
528
529void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +0000530 inherited::clear();
531 Functions.clear();
532}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000534// IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000535// overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
536// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
537// signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
538// declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000539// it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
540// cannot be overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
541// top of the underlying declaration.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000542//
543// Example: Given the following input:
544//
545// void f(int, float); // #1
546// void f(int, int); // #2
547// int f(int, int); // #3
548//
549// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000550// so IsOverload will not be used.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000551//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000552// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By
553// comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
554// (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
555// false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000556//
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000557// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
558// compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
559// nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
560// identical (return types of functions are not part of the
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000561// signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
562// point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000563//
564// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
565// into a class by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide
566// shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
567// into a function template's signature.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000568Sema::OverloadKind
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000569Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
570 NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000571 for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000572 I != E; ++I) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000573 NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
574
575 bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
576 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
577 OldIsUsingDecl = true;
578
579 // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
580 // context, even if they have identical signatures.
581 if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
582
583 OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
584 }
585
586 // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
587 // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
588 // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
589 // function templates hide function templates with different
590 // return types or template parameter lists.
591 bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
592 (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
593
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000594 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000595 if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
596 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
597 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
598 continue;
599 }
600
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000601 Match = *I;
602 return Ovl_Match;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000603 }
John McCall3d988d92009-12-02 08:47:38 +0000604 } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000605 if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
606 if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
607 HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
608 continue;
609 }
610
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000611 Match = *I;
612 return Ovl_Match;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000613 }
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000614 } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000615 // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
616 // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
617 assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
John McCalla8987a2942010-11-10 03:01:53 +0000618 } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
619 // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
John McCall84d87672009-12-10 09:41:52 +0000620 } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
621 // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
622 // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
623 // template instantiation.
624 } else {
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000625 // (C++ 13p1):
626 // Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
627 // declarations cannot be overloaded.
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000628 Match = *I;
629 return Ovl_NonFunction;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000630 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000631 }
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000632
John McCalldaa3d6b2009-12-09 03:35:25 +0000633 return Ovl_Overload;
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000634}
635
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000636bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
637 bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
John McCall8246e352010-08-12 07:09:11 +0000638 // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
639 // overloads.
640 if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
641 return false;
642
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000643 FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
644 FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
645
646 // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
647 // A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
648 // and with normal (non-template) functions.
649 if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
650 return true;
651
652 // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
653 QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
654 QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
655
656 // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
657 // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
658 // in the signature, they are overloads.
659
660 // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
661 // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
662 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
663 isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
664 return false;
665
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +0000666 const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
667 const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000668
669 // The signature of a function includes the types of its
670 // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
671 // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
672 if (OldQType != NewQType &&
673 (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
674 OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +0000675 !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000676 return true;
677
678 // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
679 // The signature of a function template consists of its function
680 // signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
681 // of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
682 // relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
683 // signature.
684 //
685 // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
686 // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +0000687 //
688 // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
689 // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
690 if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000691 (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
692 OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
693 false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
694 OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
695 return true;
696
697 // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000698 // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000699 //
700 // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
701 // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
702 // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
703 // this check is important to determine whether these functions
704 // can be overloaded.
705 CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
706 CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
707 if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
708 !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
Douglas Gregorb2f8aa92011-01-26 17:47:49 +0000709 (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000710 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
711 if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
712 OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
713 (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
714 NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
715 // C++0x [over.load]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000716 // - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
717 // parameter-type-list as well as member function template
718 // declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
719 // the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000720 // them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
721 Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
722 << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
723 Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
724 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000725
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000726 return true;
Douglas Gregorc83f98652011-01-26 21:20:37 +0000727 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000728
John McCall1f82f242009-11-18 22:49:29 +0000729 // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
730 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000731}
732
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +0000733/// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
734/// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
735/// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
736/// to perform the initialization. Given
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000737///
738/// void f(float f);
739/// void g(int i) { f(i); }
740///
741/// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
742/// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
743/// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
744/// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
745//
746/// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
747/// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
748/// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
749/// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
750/// "BadConversion".
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000751///
752/// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
753/// not permitted.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +0000754/// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
755/// permitted.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000756static ImplicitConversionSequence
757TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
758 bool SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000759 bool AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000760 bool InOverloadResolution,
761 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +0000762 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000763 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000764 ICS.Standard, CStyle)) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000765 ICS.setStandard();
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000766 return ICS;
767 }
768
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000769 if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000770 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000771 return ICS;
772 }
773
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000774 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
775 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
776 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
777 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
778 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
779 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
780 // called for those cases.
781 QualType FromType = From->getType();
782 if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000783 (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
784 S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000785 ICS.setStandard();
786 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
787 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
788 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000789
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000790 // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
791 // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
792 // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
793 // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
794 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000795
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000796 // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000797 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000798 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000799
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000800 return ICS;
801 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000802
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +0000803 if (SuppressUserConversions) {
804 // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
805 // we can perform.
806 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000807 return ICS;
808 }
809
810 // Attempt user-defined conversion.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000811 OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
812 OverloadingResult UserDefResult
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000813 = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +0000814 AllowExplicit);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +0000815
816 if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000817 ICS.setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000818 // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
819 // A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
820 // type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
821 // expression of class type to a base class of that type is
822 // given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
823 // constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
824 // called for those cases.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000825 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000826 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000827 QualType FromCanon
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000828 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
829 QualType ToCanon
830 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +0000831 if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000832 (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000833 // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
834 // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000835 ICS.setStandard();
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000836 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000837 ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +0000838 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +0000839 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
Douglas Gregorbb2e68832009-02-02 22:11:10 +0000840 if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
Douglas Gregor05379422008-11-03 17:51:48 +0000841 ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
842 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000843 }
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +0000844
845 // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
846 // However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
847 // conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
848 // invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
849 // of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
850 // 13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
851 // ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000852 if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000853 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +0000854 }
John McCalle8c8cd22010-01-13 22:30:33 +0000855 } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +0000856 ICS.setAmbiguous();
857 ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
858 ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
859 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
860 Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
861 if (Cand->Viable)
862 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000863 } else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +0000864 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
Fariborz Jahanian21ccf062009-09-23 00:58:07 +0000865 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +0000866
867 return ICS;
868}
869
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000870bool Sema::TryImplicitConversion(InitializationSequence &Sequence,
871 const InitializedEntity &Entity,
872 Expr *Initializer,
873 bool SuppressUserConversions,
874 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000875 bool InOverloadResolution,
876 bool CStyle) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000877 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
878 = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, Initializer, Entity.getType(),
879 SuppressUserConversions,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000880 AllowExplicitConversions,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000881 InOverloadResolution,
882 CStyle);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000883 if (ICS.isBad()) return true;
884
885 // Perform the actual conversion.
886 Sequence.AddConversionSequenceStep(ICS, Entity.getType());
887 return false;
888}
889
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000890/// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000891/// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000892/// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
893/// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
894/// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000895ExprResult
896Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000897 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
898 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
899 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
900}
901
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +0000902ExprResult
903Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000904 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
905 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +0000906 ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
907 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
908 AllowExplicit,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +0000909 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
910 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregorae4b5df2010-04-16 22:27:05 +0000911 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
912}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000913
914/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000915/// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000916static bool IsNoReturnConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000917 QualType ToType, QualType &ResultTy) {
918 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
919 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000920
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000921 // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
922 // where F adds one of the following at most once:
923 // - a pointer
924 // - a member pointer
925 // - a block pointer
926 CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
927 CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
928 Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
929 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
930 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
931 if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
932 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
933 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
934 } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
935 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
936 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
937 } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
938 CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
939 CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
940 } else {
941 return false;
942 }
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000943
John McCall991eb4b2010-12-21 00:44:39 +0000944 TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
945 if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
946 if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
947 return false;
948 }
949
950 const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
951 FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
952 if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
953
954 FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
955 assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
956 if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
957
958 ResultTy = ToType;
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +0000959 return true;
960}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000961
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000962/// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
963/// vector conversion.
964///
965/// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
966/// conversion.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000967static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
968 QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000969 // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
970 // conversion.
971 if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
972 return false;
973
974 // Identical types require no conversions.
975 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
976 return false;
977
978 // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
979 if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
980 // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
981 // identity conversion.
982 if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
983 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +0000984
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000985 // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +0000986 if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +0000987 ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
988 return true;
989 }
990 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +0000991
992 // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
993 // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
994 // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
995 // same size
996 if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
997 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
Chandler Carruth9c524c12010-08-08 05:02:51 +0000998 (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
999 (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001000 ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1001 return true;
1002 }
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001003 }
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00001004
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001005 return false;
1006}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001007
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001008/// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1009/// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1010/// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1011/// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1012/// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1013/// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1014/// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1015/// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001016static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1017 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001018 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1019 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001020 QualType FromType = From->getType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001021
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001022 // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00001023 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001024 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001025 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00001026 SCS.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00001027 SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001028
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001029 // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001030 // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001031 if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001032 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001033 return false;
1034
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001035 // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001036 }
1037
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001038 // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1039 // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1040 // (C++ 4p1).
1041
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001042 if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001043 DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1044 if (FunctionDecl *Fn
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001045 = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001046 AccessPair)) {
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001047 // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1048 // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1049 FromType = Fn->getType();
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00001050
1051 // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1052 // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1053 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1054 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1055 QualType resultTy;
1056 // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1057 if (!IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType,
1058 S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1059 // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1060 if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1061 return false;
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001062 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001063
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001064 // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1065 // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1066 // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1067 // expression.
1068 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1069 if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1070 assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1071 "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1072 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1073 == UO_AddrOf &&
1074 "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1075 const Type *ClassType
1076 = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1077 FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
Chandler Carruth7750f762011-03-29 18:38:10 +00001078 } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1079 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1080 UO_AddrOf &&
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001081 "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1082 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1083 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001084
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001085 // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00001086 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1087 FromType,
1088 S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
Douglas Gregor980fb162010-04-29 18:24:40 +00001089 } else {
1090 return false;
1091 }
Anders Carlssonba37e1e2010-11-04 05:28:09 +00001092 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001093 // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++ 4.1):
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001094 // An lvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can be
1095 // converted to an rvalue.
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001096 bool argIsLValue = From->isLValue();
1097 if (argIsLValue &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00001098 !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001099 S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001100 SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001101
1102 // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1103 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001104 // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1105 // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001106 FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001107 } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1108 // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001109 SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001110
1111 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1112 // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1113 // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001114 FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001115
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001116 if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001117 // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00001118 SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001119
1120 // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1121 // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1122 // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1123 // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001124 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1125 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001126 SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001127 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001128 }
John McCall086a4642010-11-24 05:12:34 +00001129 } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001130 // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001131 SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001132
1133 // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1134 // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1135 // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001136 FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001137 } else {
1138 // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001139 SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001140 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001141 SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001142
1143 // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1144 // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1145 // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1146 // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001147 // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1148 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001149 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001150 ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001151 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001152 // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1153 // conversion to do.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001154 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001155 } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001156 // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001157 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001158 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001159 } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001160 // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001161 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001162 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001163 } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001164 // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001165 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1166 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001167 } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1168 (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1169 FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1170 FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1171 FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1172 FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1173 // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1174 SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1175 FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001176 } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001177 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001178 // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001179 SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001180 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001181 } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001182 // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001183 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1184 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001185 } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1186 (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001187 // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1188 SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1189 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001190 } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
Chandler Carruth8fa1e7e2010-02-25 07:20:54 +00001191 // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1192 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1193 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001194 } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001195 ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001196 (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
Douglas Gregor49b4d732010-06-22 23:07:26 +00001197 ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001198 // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001199 SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001200 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001201 } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1202 SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001203 } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1204 FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001205 // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001206 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001207 SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001208 } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001209 InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001210 // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001211 SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001212 } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001213 SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1214 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001215 } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1216 S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00001217 // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001218 SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
Douglas Gregor46188682010-05-18 22:42:18 +00001219 FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001220 } else if (IsNoReturnConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00001221 // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1222 SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001223 } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1224 InOverloadResolution,
1225 SCS, CStyle)) {
1226 SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1227 FromType = ToType;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001228 } else {
1229 // No second conversion required.
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001230 SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001231 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001232 SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001233
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001234 QualType CanonFrom;
1235 QualType CanonTo;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001236 // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00001237 if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle)) {
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001238 SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001239 FromType = ToType;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001240 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1241 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001242 } else {
1243 // No conversion required
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001244 SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1245
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001246 // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001247 // [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1248 // subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1249 // a conversion. [...]
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00001250 CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1251 CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001252 if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001253 == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
Fariborz Jahanian9f963c22010-05-18 23:04:17 +00001254 (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1255 || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr())) {
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001256 FromType = ToType;
1257 CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1258 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001259 }
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00001260 SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001261
1262 // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1263 // this is a bad conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00001264 if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001265 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001266
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00001267 return true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001268}
Fariborz Jahanian16f92ce2011-03-23 19:50:54 +00001269
1270static bool
1271IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1272 QualType &ToType,
1273 bool InOverloadResolution,
1274 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1275 bool CStyle) {
1276
1277 const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1278 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1279 return false;
1280 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1281 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1282 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1283 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1284 itend = UD->field_end();
1285 it != itend; ++it) {
1286 if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS, CStyle)) {
1287 ToType = it->getType();
1288 return true;
1289 }
1290 }
1291 return false;
1292}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001293
1294/// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1295/// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1296/// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1297/// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001298bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001299 const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
Sebastian Redlee547972008-11-04 15:59:10 +00001300 // All integers are built-in.
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001301 if (!To) {
1302 return false;
1303 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001304
1305 // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1306 // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1307 // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1308 // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1309 // int (C++ 4.5p1).
Douglas Gregora71cc152010-02-02 20:10:50 +00001310 if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1311 !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001312 if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1313 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1314 // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1315 // less than int to an int.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001316 (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001317 Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001318 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001319 }
1320
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001321 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1322 }
1323
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001324 // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1325 // A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1326 // fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1327 // following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1328 // (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1329 // unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001330 // long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001331 // values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001332 // type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001333 // with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1334 // long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001335 // there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001336 if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1337 // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1338 // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1339 if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1340 return false;
1341
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001342 // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001343 if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
Douglas Gregorc87f4d42010-09-12 03:38:25 +00001344 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001345 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1346 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00001347 }
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001348
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001349 // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001350 // A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1351 // to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1352 // represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001353 // long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001354 // If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001355 // underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001356 // or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001357 // type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001358 if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
Douglas Gregorcd1d0b42010-10-21 18:04:08 +00001359 ToType->isIntegerType()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001360 // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1361 // unsigned.
1362 bool FromIsSigned;
1363 uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001364
John McCall56774992009-12-09 09:09:27 +00001365 // FIXME: Is wchar_t signed or unsigned? We assume it's signed for now.
1366 FromIsSigned = true;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001367
1368 // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1369 // order. Try each of these types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001370 QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1371 Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001372 Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1373 Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001374 };
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00001375 for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001376 uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1377 if (FromSize < ToSize ||
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001378 (FromSize == ToSize &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001379 FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1380 // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1381 // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1382 // promotion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001383 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001384 }
1385 }
1386 }
1387
1388 // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1389 // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1390 // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1391 // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1392 // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1393 // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1394 // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00001395 // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1396 // conversion.
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001397 using llvm::APSInt;
1398 if (From)
1399 if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001400 APSInt BitWidth;
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00001401 if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00001402 MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1403 APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1404 ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001405
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001406 // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1407 if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1408 (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1409 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1410 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001411
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001412 // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1413 // that fits into an unsigned int?
1414 if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1415 return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1416 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001417
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00001418 return false;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001419 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001420 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001421
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001422 // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1423 // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001424 if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001425 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001426 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001427
1428 return false;
1429}
1430
1431/// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1432/// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1433/// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001434bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001435 /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1436 /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001437 if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1438 if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001439 if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1440 ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1441 return true;
1442
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001443 // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1444 // When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1445 // double is promoted to long double [...].
1446 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1447 (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1448 FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1449 (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1450 return true;
1451 }
1452
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001453 return false;
1454}
1455
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001456/// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1457///
1458/// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1459/// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001460/// floating-point or integral promotion.
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001461bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001462 const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001463 if (!FromComplex)
1464 return false;
1465
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001466 const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001467 if (!ToComplex)
1468 return false;
1469
1470 return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
Douglas Gregor67525022009-02-12 00:26:06 +00001471 ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1472 IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1473 ToComplex->getElementType());
Douglas Gregor78ca74d2009-02-12 00:15:05 +00001474}
1475
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001476/// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1477/// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1478/// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1479/// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1480/// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001481static QualType
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001482BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001483 QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1484 ASTContext &Context) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001485 assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1486 FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1487 "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001488
Douglas Gregorc6bd1d32010-12-06 22:09:19 +00001489 /// \brief Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1490 if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1491 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001492
1493 QualType CanonFromPointee
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001494 = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001495 QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001496 Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001497
1498 // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00001499 if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001500 // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001501 if (!ToType.isNull())
Douglas Gregorb9f907b2010-05-25 15:31:05 +00001502 return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001503
1504 // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1505 // already.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001506 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1507 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001508 return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1509 }
1510
1511 // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001512 QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1513 = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001514
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001515 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1516 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1517 return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001518}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001519
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001520static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001521 bool InOverloadResolution,
1522 ASTContext &Context) {
1523 // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1524 // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1525 if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00001526 Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001527 return !InOverloadResolution;
1528
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00001529 return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1530 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1531 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001532}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001533
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001534/// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1535/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1536/// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1537/// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1538/// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1539/// ConvertedType.
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001540///
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00001541/// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1542/// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1543/// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1544/// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1545/// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1546/// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001547/// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1548/// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1549/// should result in a warning.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001550bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00001551 bool InOverloadResolution,
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001552 QualType& ConvertedType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001553 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001554 IncompatibleObjC = false;
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001555 if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1556 IncompatibleObjC))
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001557 return true;
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00001558
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001559 // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1560 if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001561 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor79a6b012008-12-22 20:51:52 +00001562 ConvertedType = ToType;
1563 return true;
1564 }
1565
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001566 // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1567 if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001568 ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001569 ConvertedType = ToType;
1570 return true;
1571 }
1572 // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1573 // pointer type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001574 if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001575 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor231d1c62008-11-27 00:15:41 +00001576 ConvertedType = ToType;
1577 return true;
1578 }
1579
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001580 // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1581 // pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001582 if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001583 isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00001584 ConvertedType = ToType;
1585 return true;
1586 }
1587
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001588 const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001589 if (!ToTypePtr)
1590 return false;
1591
1592 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
Anders Carlsson759b7892009-08-28 15:55:56 +00001593 if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001594 ConvertedType = ToType;
1595 return true;
1596 }
Sebastian Redl72b8aef2008-10-31 14:43:28 +00001597
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001598 // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001599 // , including objective-c pointers.
1600 QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1601 if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001602 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1603 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1604 ToPointeeType,
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001605 ToType, Context);
1606 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian01cbe442009-12-16 23:13:33 +00001607 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001608 const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001609 if (!FromTypePtr)
1610 return false;
1611
1612 QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001613
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001614 // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
Douglas Gregorfb640862010-08-18 21:25:30 +00001615 // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1616 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1617 return false;
1618
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001619 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1620 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1621 // 4.10p2).
Eli Friedmana170cd62010-08-05 02:49:48 +00001622 if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1623 ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001625 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001626 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001627 return true;
1628 }
1629
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001630 // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1631 // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001632 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001633 Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001634 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001635 ToPointeeType,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001636 ToType, Context);
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001637 return true;
1638 }
1639
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001640 // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001641 //
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001642 // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1643 // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1644 // B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1645 // (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1646 // necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1647 // conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1648 // derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1649 // the null pointer value of the destination type.
1650 //
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001651 // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1652 // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
Douglas Gregor4e5cbdc2009-02-11 23:02:49 +00001653 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1654 FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
Douglas Gregord28f0412010-02-22 17:06:41 +00001655 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
Douglas Gregore6fb91f2009-10-29 23:08:22 +00001656 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001657 IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001658 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
Douglas Gregorbb9bf882008-11-27 00:52:49 +00001659 ToPointeeType,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00001660 ToType, Context);
1661 return true;
1662 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00001663
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001664 return false;
1665}
1666
1667/// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1668/// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1669/// with the same arguments and return values.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001670bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001671 QualType& ConvertedType,
1672 bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1673 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1674 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001675
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001676 // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001677 const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1678 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001679 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001680 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001681
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001682 if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001683 // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1684 // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1685 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1686 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1687 return false;
1688
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001689 // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001690 // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00001691 if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001692 ConvertedType = ToType;
1693 return true;
1694 }
1695 // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001696 if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001697 ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001698 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
Steve Naroff8e6aee52009-07-23 01:01:38 +00001699 /*compare=*/false)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001700 ConvertedType = ToType;
1701 return true;
1702 }
1703 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1704 // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1705 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
Fariborz Jahanianb397e432010-03-15 18:36:00 +00001706 const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1707 const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1708 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1709 !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1710 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1711 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001712 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001713 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1714 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001715 return true;
1716 }
1717
1718 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1719 // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1720 // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1721 // complain about it.
1722 IncompatibleObjC = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001723 ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001724 ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1725 ToType, Context);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001726 return true;
1727 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001728 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001729 // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001730 QualType ToPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001731 if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001732 ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001733 else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001734 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001735 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001736 // to a block pointer type.
1737 if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1738 ConvertedType = ToType;
1739 return true;
1740 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001741 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanian4efdec02010-01-20 22:54:38 +00001742 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001743 else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001744 ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001745 // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
Fariborz Jahanian879cc732010-01-21 00:08:17 +00001746 // pointer to any object.
Fariborz Jahaniane4951fd2010-01-21 00:05:09 +00001747 ConvertedType = ToType;
1748 return true;
1749 }
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001750 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001751 return false;
1752
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001753 QualType FromPointeeType;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001754 if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00001755 FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00001756 else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1757 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001758 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1759 else
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001760 return false;
1761
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001762 // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1763 // is an Objective-C conversion.
1764 if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1765 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1766 IncompatibleObjC)) {
1767 // We always complain about this conversion.
1768 IncompatibleObjC = true;
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001769 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001770 return true;
1771 }
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001772 // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1773 // as in I* to id.
1774 if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1775 ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1776 isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1777 IncompatibleObjC)) {
Douglas Gregor8d6d0672010-12-01 21:43:58 +00001778 ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
Fariborz Jahanian42ffdb32010-01-18 22:59:22 +00001779 return true;
1780 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001781
Douglas Gregor033f56d2008-12-23 00:53:59 +00001782 // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001783 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1784 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1785 // complain about it).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001786 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001787 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00001788 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001789 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001790 if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1791 // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1792 // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1793 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1794 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1795 return false;
1796
1797 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1798 // function types are obviously different.
1799 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1800 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1801 FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1802 return false;
1803
1804 bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1805 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1806 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1807 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1808 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1809 ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1810 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1811 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1812 HasObjCConversion = true;
1813 } else {
1814 // Function types are too different. Abort.
1815 return false;
1816 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001817
Douglas Gregora119f102008-12-19 19:13:09 +00001818 // Check argument types.
1819 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1820 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1821 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1822 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1823 if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1824 == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1825 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1826 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1827 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1828 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1829 HasObjCConversion = true;
1830 } else {
1831 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1832 return false;
1833 }
1834 }
1835
1836 if (HasObjCConversion) {
1837 // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
1838 // conversion, but complain about it.
1839 ConvertedType = ToType;
1840 IncompatibleObjC = true;
1841 return true;
1842 }
1843 }
1844
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00001845 return false;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001846}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001847
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001848bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1849 QualType& ConvertedType) {
1850 QualType ToPointeeType;
1851 if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1852 ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1853 ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1854 else
1855 return false;
1856
1857 QualType FromPointeeType;
1858 if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1859 FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1860 FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1861 else
1862 return false;
1863 // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
1864 // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1865 // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
1866
1867 const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
1868 = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1869 const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
1870 = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1871
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001872 if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
1873 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001874
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001875 if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001876 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001877
1878 // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1879 // function types are obviously different.
1880 if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1881 FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
1882 return false;
1883
1884 FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1885 FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
1886 if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
1887 return false;
1888
1889 bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
Fariborz Jahanian12834e12011-02-13 20:11:42 +00001890 if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1891 ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
Fariborz Jahanian4de45dc2011-02-13 20:01:48 +00001892 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1893 } else {
1894 QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
1895 QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
1896 if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
1897 !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
1898 LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
1899
1900 if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
1901 // OK exact match.
1902 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
1903 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1904 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1905 return false;
1906 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1907 }
1908 else
1909 return false;
1910 }
1911
1912 // Check argument types.
1913 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1914 ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1915 IncompatibleObjC = false;
1916 QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1917 QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1918 if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
1919 // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1920 } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
1921 ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1922 if (IncompatibleObjC)
1923 return false;
1924 // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1925 } else
1926 // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1927 return false;
1928 }
1929 ConvertedType = ToType;
1930 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian42455ea2011-02-12 19:07:46 +00001931}
1932
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001933/// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
1934/// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
1935/// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
1936/// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001937bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
John McCall424cec92011-01-19 06:33:43 +00001938 const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001939 if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1940 return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
1941 NewType->arg_type_begin());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001942
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001943 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
1944 N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
1945 E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
1946 QualType ToType = (*O);
1947 QualType FromType = (*N);
1948 if (ToType != FromType) {
1949 if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1950 if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
Chandler Carruth27c9fe92010-05-06 00:15:06 +00001951 if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
1952 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
1953 (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
1954 PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001955 continue;
1956 }
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001957 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
1958 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001959 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00001960 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
1961 if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
1962 continue;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001963 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00001964 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian5e5998f2010-05-03 21:06:18 +00001965 }
1966 }
1967 return true;
1968}
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00001969
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001970/// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
1971/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00001972/// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001973/// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
1974/// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
1975/// error, or returns false otherwise.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00001976bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001977 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001978 CXXCastPath& BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00001979 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001980 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001981 bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001982
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00001983 Kind = CK_BitCast;
1984
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001985 if (CXXBoolLiteralExpr* LitBool
1986 = dyn_cast<CXXBoolLiteralExpr>(From->IgnoreParens()))
Argyrios Kyrtzidisd6ea6bd2010-09-28 14:54:11 +00001987 if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && LitBool->getValue() == false)
Chandler Carruth477a9992011-03-01 03:29:37 +00001988 DiagRuntimeBehavior(LitBool->getExprLoc(), From,
1989 PDiag(diag::warn_init_pointer_from_false) << ToType);
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00001990
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00001991 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1992 if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001993 QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
1994 ToPointeeType = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor1e57a3f2008-12-18 23:43:31 +00001995
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001996 if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
1997 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00001998 // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
1999 // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002000 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2001 From->getExprLoc(),
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00002002 From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002003 IgnoreBaseAccess))
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002004 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002005
Anders Carlsson7ec8ccd2009-09-12 04:46:44 +00002006 // The conversion was successful.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002007 Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002008 }
2009 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002010 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002011 FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002012 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002013 ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002014 // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2015 // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2016 // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00002017 if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002018 return false;
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002019 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002020 }
John McCall8cb679e2010-11-15 09:13:47 +00002021
2022 // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2023 // reasons.
2024 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2025 Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2026
Douglas Gregor39c16d42008-10-24 04:54:22 +00002027 return false;
2028}
2029
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002030/// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2031/// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2032/// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2033/// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2034/// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2035bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002036 QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002037 bool InOverloadResolution,
2038 QualType &ConvertedType) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002039 const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002040 if (!ToTypePtr)
2041 return false;
2042
2043 // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002044 if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2045 InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2046 : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002047 ConvertedType = ToType;
2048 return true;
2049 }
2050
2051 // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002052 const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002053 if (!FromTypePtr)
2054 return false;
2055
2056 // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2057 // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2058 QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2059 QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002060
Douglas Gregor7f6ae692010-12-21 21:40:41 +00002061 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2062 !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2063 IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002064 ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2065 ToClass.getTypePtr());
2066 return true;
2067 }
2068
2069 return false;
2070}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002071
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002072/// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2073/// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002074/// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002075/// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2076/// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2077/// otherwise.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002078bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002079 CastKind &Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00002080 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Sebastian Redl7c353682009-11-14 21:15:49 +00002081 bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002082 QualType FromType = From->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002083 const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002084 if (!FromPtrType) {
2085 // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002086 assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00002087 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002088 "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002089 Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002090 return false;
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002091 }
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002092
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002093 const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002094 assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2095 "that is not a member pointer.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002096
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002097 QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2098 QualType ToClass = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002099
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002100 // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2101 assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2102 assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002103
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002104 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
Douglas Gregor36d1b142009-10-06 17:59:45 +00002105 /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002106 bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2107 assert(DerivationOkay &&
2108 "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2109 (void)DerivationOkay;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002110
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002111 if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2112 getUnqualifiedType())) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002113 std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2114 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2115 << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2116 return true;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002117 }
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002118
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002119 if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002120 Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2121 << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2122 << From->getSourceRange();
2123 return true;
2124 }
2125
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002126 if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
John McCall1064d7e2010-03-16 05:22:47 +00002127 CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2128 Paths.front(),
2129 diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
John McCall5b0829a2010-02-10 09:31:12 +00002130
Anders Carlssond7923c62009-08-22 23:33:40 +00002131 // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
Anders Carlsson7d3360f2010-04-24 19:36:51 +00002132 BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002133 Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
Sebastian Redl72b597d2009-01-25 19:43:20 +00002134 return false;
2135}
2136
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002137/// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2138/// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2139/// (C++ 4.4).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002140bool
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002141Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002142 bool CStyle) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002143 FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2144 ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2145
2146 // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2147 // qualification conversion.
Sebastian Redlcbdffb12010-02-03 19:36:07 +00002148 if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002149 return false;
Sebastian Redled8f2002009-01-28 18:33:18 +00002150
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002151 // (C++ 4.4p4):
2152 // A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2153 // in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2154 bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002155 bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002156 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002157 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2158 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2159 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002160 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002161 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2162 // unwrap.
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002163 UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002164
2165 // -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2166 // 2,j, and similarly for volatile.
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002167 if (!CStyle && !ToType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromType))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002168 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002169
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002170 // -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2171 // every cv for 0 < k < j.
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00002172 if (!CStyle && FromType.getCVRQualifiers() != ToType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002173 && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002174 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002175
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002176 // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2177 // include const.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002178 PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002179 = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToType.isConstQualified();
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002180 }
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002181
2182 // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2183 // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2184 // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2185 // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2186 // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00002187 return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00002188}
2189
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002190/// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2191/// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2192/// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2193/// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2194/// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2195/// false and User is unspecified.
2196///
Douglas Gregor576e98c2009-01-30 23:27:23 +00002197/// \param AllowExplicit true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2198/// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2199/// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002200static OverloadingResult
2201IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2202 UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2203 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2204 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002205 // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2206 bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2207
2208 // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2209 // constructors.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002210 if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002211 // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2212 // When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2213 // copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2214 // derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2215 // constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2216 // functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2217 // that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2218 // the parentheses of the initializer.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002219 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002220 (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002221 S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002222 ConstructorsOnly = true;
2223
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002224 if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag())) {
Douglas Gregor3ec1bf22009-11-05 13:06:35 +00002225 // We're not going to find any constructors.
2226 } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2227 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002228 DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002229 for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002230 Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002231 NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2232 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2233
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002234 // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2235 CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2236 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002237 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002238 if (ConstructorTmpl)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002239 Constructor
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002240 = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2241 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002242 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002243
Fariborz Jahanian11a8e952009-08-06 17:22:51 +00002244 if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
Anders Carlssond20e7952009-08-28 16:57:08 +00002245 Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002246 if (ConstructorTmpl)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002247 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2248 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002249 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002250 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2251 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002252 else
Fariborz Jahanianb3c44f92009-10-01 20:39:51 +00002253 // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2254 // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002255 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2256 &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2257 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2258 !ConstructorsOnly);
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00002259 }
Douglas Gregor89ee6822009-02-28 01:32:25 +00002260 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002261 }
2262 }
2263
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002264 // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2265 if (ConstructorsOnly) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002266 } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2267 S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00002268 // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002269 } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002270 = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271 if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002272 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2273 // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002274 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Fariborz Jahanianf4061e32009-09-14 20:41:01 +00002275 = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00002276 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002277 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00002278 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2279 NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00002280 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2281 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2282 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2283
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002284 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2285 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002286 if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2287 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002288 else
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00002289 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002290
2291 if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2292 if (ConvTemplate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002293 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2294 ActingContext, From, ToType,
2295 CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002296 else
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002297 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2298 From, ToType, CandidateSet);
Fariborz Jahanianf9012a32009-09-11 18:46:22 +00002299 }
2300 }
2301 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002302 }
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002303
2304 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00002305 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002306 case OR_Success:
2307 // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2308 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2309 = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002310 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2311
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002312 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2313 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2314 // constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2315 // sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2316 // the argument of the constructor.
2317 //
2318 QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2319 if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2320 User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2321 else {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00002322 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00002323 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002324 }
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002325 User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002326 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002327 User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2328 User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2329 User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2330 return OR_Success;
2331 } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2332 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00002333 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2334
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002335 // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2336 //
2337 // [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2338 // conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2339 // conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2340 // implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2341 User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2342 User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00002343 User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002344 User.EllipsisConversion = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002345
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002346 // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2347 // The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2348 // result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2349 // for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2350 // is an initialization, the special rules for
2351 // initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2352 // selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2353 // user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2354 // 13.3.3.1).
2355 User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2356 return OR_Success;
2357 } else {
2358 llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002359 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002360 }
2361
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002362 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2363 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2364 case OR_Deleted:
2365 // No conversion here! We're done.
2366 return OR_Deleted;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002367
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002368 case OR_Ambiguous:
2369 return OR_Ambiguous;
2370 }
2371
Fariborz Jahanian3e6b57e2009-09-15 19:12:21 +00002372 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002373}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002374
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002375bool
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002376Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002377 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00002378 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002379 OverloadingResult OvResult =
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002380 IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002381 CandidateSet, false);
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00002382 if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2383 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2384 diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2385 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2386 else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2387 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2388 diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2389 << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2390 else
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002391 return false;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002392 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002393 return true;
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00002394}
Douglas Gregor26bee0b2008-10-31 16:23:19 +00002395
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002396/// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2397/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2398/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002399static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2400CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2401 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2402 const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002403{
2404 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2405 // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2406 // -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2407 // conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2408 // an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2409 // -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2410 // conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2411 // (13.3.3.1.3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002412 //
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002413 // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2414 // For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2415 // described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2416 // treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2417 // from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002418 if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2419 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2420 else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2421 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002422
Benjamin Kramer98ff7f82010-04-18 12:05:54 +00002423 // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2424 // the same kind.
2425 if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2426 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2427
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002428 // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2429 // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2430 // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002431 if (ICS1.isStandard())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002432 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002433 else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002434 // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2435 // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2436 // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2437 // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2438 // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2439 // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002440 if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002441 ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002442 return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2443 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002444 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2445 }
2446
2447 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2448}
2449
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002450static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2451 while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2452 Qualifiers Quals;
2453 T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002454 T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002455 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002456
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002457 return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2458}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002459
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002460// Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2461// determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2462static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2463compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2464 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2465 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2466 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2467 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2468
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002469 // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
Douglas Gregore87561a2010-05-23 22:10:15 +00002470 // any non-identity conversion sequence
2471 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding == SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2472 if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2473 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2474 else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2475 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2476 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002477
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002478 if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2479 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2480 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2481 else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2482 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2483 else
2484 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Douglas Gregor1fc3d662010-06-09 03:53:18 +00002485 } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002486 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2487
2488 if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2489 return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2490 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2491 }
2492
2493 if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2494 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2495 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2496 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2497
2498 if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2499 return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2500 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2501 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002502
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002503 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2504}
2505
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002506/// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2507/// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2508static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2509 const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2510 // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2511 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2512 // implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002513 // without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002514 // to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002515 // lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002516 // reference*.
2517 //
2518 // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2519 // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2520 // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2521 // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2522 // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00002523 if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2524 SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2525 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002526
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002527 return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2528 SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2529 (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2530 !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2531}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002532
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002533/// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2534/// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2535/// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002536static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2537CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2538 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2539 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002540{
2541 // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2542 // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2543
2544 // -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2545 // sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2546 // excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2547 // sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2548 // non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002549 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002550 = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002551 return CK;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002552
2553 // -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2554 // defined below), or, if not that,
2555 ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2556 ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2557 if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2558 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2559 else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2560 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002561
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002562 // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2563 // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2564 // applies:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002565
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002566 // A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2567 // pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2568 // that is such a conversion.
2569 if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2570 return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2571 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2572 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2573
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002574 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2575 //
2576 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002577 // conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2578 // void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2579 // of B* to void*.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002580 bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002581 = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002582 bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002583 = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002584 if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2585 // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2586 // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002587 return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2588 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002589 } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2590 // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2591 // their derived-to-base conversions.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002592 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002593 = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002594 return DerivedCK;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002595 } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2596 // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2597 // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2598 // inheritance relationship in their sources.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002599 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2600 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002601
2602 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2603 // conversion, if we need to.
2604 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002605 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002606 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002607 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002608
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002609 QualType FromPointee1
2610 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2611 QualType FromPointee2
2612 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002613
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002614 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002615 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002616 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002617 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2618
2619 // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2620 // other, it is the better one.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002621 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface1 = FromPointee1->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
2622 const ObjCObjectType* FromIface2 = FromPointee2->getAs<ObjCObjectType>();
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002623 if (FromIface1 && FromIface1) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002624 if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface2, FromIface1))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002625 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002626 else if (S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromIface1, FromIface2))
Douglas Gregor1aa450a2009-12-13 21:37:05 +00002627 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2628 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002629 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002630
2631 // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2632 // bullet 3).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002633 if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002634 = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002635 return QualCK;
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002636
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002637 if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00002638 // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2639 if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2640 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2641 else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2642 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002643
Sebastian Redlb28b4072009-03-22 23:49:27 +00002644 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2645 // -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2646 // which the references refer are the same type except for
2647 // top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2648 // initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2649 // to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002650 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2651 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002652 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2653 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002654 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002655 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2656 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002657 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00002658 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2659 // type for comparison.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002660 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002661 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002662 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002663 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002664 if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2665 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2666 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2667 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2668 }
2669 }
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002670
2671 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2672}
2673
2674/// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2675/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002676/// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2677ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002678CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2679 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2680 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
Douglas Gregor4b62ec62008-10-22 15:04:37 +00002681 // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002682 // -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2683 // yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2684 // cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
2685 // the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
2686 // deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
2687 if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
2688 SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
2689 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2690
2691 // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
2692 // conversion (!)
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002693 QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2694 QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002695 T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2696 T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002697 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002698 QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2699 QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002700
2701 // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
2702 // them.
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002703 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002704 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2705
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002706 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
2707 // for comparison.
2708 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002709 T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002710 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002711 T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
Chandler Carruth607f38e2009-12-29 07:16:59 +00002712
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002713 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002714 = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002715 while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002716 // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2717 // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2718 // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
Douglas Gregor29a92472008-10-22 17:49:05 +00002719 // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002720 // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
2721 // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
2722 // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
2723 // strict subset of qualifiers.
2724 if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
2725 // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
2726 // about how the sequences rank.
2727 ;
2728 else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
2729 // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2730 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
2731 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2732 // qualifiers.
2733 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002734
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002735 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2736 } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
2737 // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
2738 if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
2739 // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
2740 // qualifiers.
2741 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002742
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002743 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2744 } else {
2745 // Qualifiers are disjoint.
2746 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2747 }
2748
2749 // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002750 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002751 break;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002752 }
2753
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002754 // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
2755 // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
2756 switch (Result) {
2757 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002758 if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002759 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2760 break;
2761
2762 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
2763 break;
2764
2765 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
Douglas Gregore489a7d2010-02-28 18:30:25 +00002766 if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
Douglas Gregore1eb9d82008-10-22 14:17:15 +00002767 Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2768 break;
2769 }
2770
2771 return Result;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00002772}
2773
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002774/// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2775/// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002776/// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
2777/// [over.ics.rank]p4b3). As part of these checks, we also look at
2778/// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002779ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002780CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
2781 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2782 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002783 QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002784 QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00002785 QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00002786 QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002787
2788 // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2789 // conversion, if we need to.
2790 if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002791 FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002792 if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002793 FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002794
2795 // Canonicalize all of the types.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002796 FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
2797 ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
2798 FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
2799 ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002800
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002801 // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002802 //
2803 // If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
2804 // class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002805 //
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002806 // Compare based on pointer conversions.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002807 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
Douglas Gregora29dc052008-11-27 01:19:21 +00002808 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2809 /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
2810 FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
2811 ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002812 QualType FromPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002813 = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002814 QualType ToPointee1
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002815 = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002816 QualType FromPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002817 = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002818 QualType ToPointee2
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002819 = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregor237f96c2008-11-26 23:31:11 +00002820
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002821 // -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002822 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002823 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002824 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002825 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002826 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2827 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002828
2829 // -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
2830 if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002831 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002832 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002833 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002834 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002835 }
2836 } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
2837 SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
2838 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
2839 = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2840 const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
2841 = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2842 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
2843 = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2844 const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
2845 = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2846
2847 if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
2848 // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
2849 // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
2850 // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
2851 // Objective-C pointer types.
2852 bool FromAssignLeft
2853 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
2854 bool FromAssignRight
2855 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
2856 bool ToAssignLeft
2857 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
2858 bool ToAssignRight
2859 = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
2860
2861 // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
2862 // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
2863 if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
2864 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2865 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2866 if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
2867 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2868 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2869
2870 // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
2871 // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
2872 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2873 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2874 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2875 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2876
2877 // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
2878 // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
2879 if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2880 (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
2881 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2882 if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
2883 (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
2884 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2885
2886 // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
2887 // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
2888 if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
2889 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2890 if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
2891 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002892
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002893 // -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2894 if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2895 !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
2896 (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
2897 return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2898 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2899
2900 // -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
2901 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
2902 (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
2903 return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2904 : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002905 }
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002906 }
Douglas Gregor058d3de2011-01-31 18:51:41 +00002907
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002908 // Ranking of member-pointer types.
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002909 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
2910 FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
2911 ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002912 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002913 FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002914 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002915 ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002916 const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002917 FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002918 const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002919 ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2920 const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
2921 const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
2922 const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
2923 const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
2924 QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2925 QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2926 QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
2927 QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
Fariborz Jahanianac741ff2009-10-20 20:07:35 +00002928 // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002929 if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002930 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002931 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002932 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002933 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2934 }
2935 // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
2936 if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002937 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002938 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002939 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
Fariborz Jahanian9a587b02009-10-20 20:04:46 +00002940 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2941 }
2942 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00002943
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00002944 if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002945 // -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002946 // -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
2947 // B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2948 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002949 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2950 !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2951 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002952 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002953 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002954 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2955 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002956
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002957 // -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
Douglas Gregor83af86a2010-02-25 19:01:05 +00002958 // -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
2959 // A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
2960 // reference of type A&,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002961 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
2962 S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
2963 if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002964 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00002965 else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00002966 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2967 }
2968 }
Douglas Gregoref30a5f2008-10-29 14:50:44 +00002969
Douglas Gregor5c407d92008-10-23 00:40:37 +00002970 return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2971}
2972
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002973/// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
2974/// determine whether they are reference-related,
2975/// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
2976/// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
2977/// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
2978/// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
2979/// type being initialized.
2980Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
2981Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
2982 QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002983 bool &DerivedToBase,
2984 bool &ObjCConversion) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00002985 assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
2986 "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
2987 assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
2988
2989 QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
2990 QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
2991 Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2992 QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2993 QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2994
2995 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
2996 // Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
2997 // reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
2998 // T1 is a base class of T2.
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00002999 DerivedToBase = false;
3000 ObjCConversion = false;
3001 if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3002 // Nothing to do.
3003 } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003004 IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3005 DerivedToBase = true;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003006 else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3007 UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3008 Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3009 ObjCConversion = true;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003010 else
3011 return Ref_Incompatible;
3012
3013 // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3014 // least).
3015
3016 // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3017 // for comparison.
3018 if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3019 T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3020 if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3021 T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3022
3023 // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3024 // "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3025 // reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3026 // as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3027 // overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3028 // cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3029 // reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
3030 if (T1Quals.getCVRQualifiers() == T2Quals.getCVRQualifiers())
3031 return Ref_Compatible;
3032 else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3033 return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3034 else
3035 return Ref_Related;
3036}
3037
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003038/// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003039/// with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3040static bool
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003041FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3042 QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3043 Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3044 bool AllowExplicit) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003045 assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3046 CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3047 = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3048
3049 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3050 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3051 = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3052 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3053 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3054 NamedDecl *D = *I;
3055 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3056 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3057 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3058
3059 FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3060 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3061 CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3062 if (ConvTemplate)
3063 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3064 else
3065 Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3066
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003067 // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003068 // explicit conversions, skip it.
3069 if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3070 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003071
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003072 if (AllowRvalues) {
3073 bool DerivedToBase = false;
3074 bool ObjCConversion = false;
3075 if (!ConvTemplate &&
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00003076 S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3077 DeclLoc,
3078 Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3079 .getUnqualifiedType(),
3080 DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
3081 DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion) ==
3082 Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003083 continue;
3084 } else {
3085 // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3086 // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3087 // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3088
3089 const ReferenceType *RefType =
3090 Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3091 if (!RefType ||
3092 (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3093 !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3094 continue;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003095 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003096
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003097 if (ConvTemplate)
3098 S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003099 Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003100 else
3101 S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003102 DeclType, CandidateSet);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003103 }
3104
3105 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00003106 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003107 case OR_Success:
3108 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3109 //
3110 // [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3111 // applying a conversion function to the argument
3112 // expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3113 // user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3114 // second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3115 // conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3116 // entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3117 // type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3118 if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3119 return false;
3120
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00003121 if (Best->Function)
3122 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003123 ICS.setUserDefined();
3124 ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3125 ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3126 ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00003127 ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl.getDecl();
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003128 ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3129 assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3130 ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3131 "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3132 return true;
3133
3134 case OR_Ambiguous:
3135 ICS.setAmbiguous();
3136 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3137 Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3138 if (Cand->Viable)
3139 ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3140 return true;
3141
3142 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3143 case OR_Deleted:
3144 // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3145 // conversion; continue with other checks.
3146 return false;
3147 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003148
Eric Christopheraba9fb22010-06-30 18:36:32 +00003149 return false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003150}
3151
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003152/// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3153/// initialization.
3154static ImplicitConversionSequence
3155TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3156 SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3157 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003158 bool AllowExplicit) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003159 assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3160
3161 // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3162 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3163 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3164
3165 QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3166 QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3167
3168 // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3169 // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3170 // type of the resulting function.
3171 if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3172 DeclAccessPair Found;
3173 if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3174 false, Found))
3175 T2 = Fn->getType();
3176 }
3177
3178 // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3179 bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3180 bool DerivedToBase = false;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003181 bool ObjCConversion = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003182 Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003183 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003184 = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
3185 ObjCConversion);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003186
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003187
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003188 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003189 // A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3190 // of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3191
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003192 // -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003193 if (!isRValRef) {
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003194 // -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3195 // reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3196 //
3197 // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3198 if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3199 RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003200 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003201 // When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3202 // to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3203 // is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3204 // has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3205 // in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3206 // derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3207 ICS.setStandard();
3208 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
Douglas Gregor8b2d2fe2010-08-07 11:51:51 +00003209 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3210 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3211 : ICK_Identity;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003212 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3213 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3214 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3215 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3216 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3217 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3218 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003219 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3220 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3221 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003222 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003223 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003224
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003225 // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3226 // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3227 // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3228 // [over.best.ics]p2).
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003229 return ICS;
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003230 }
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003231
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003232 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3233 // not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3234 // converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3235 // is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3236 // conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3237 // conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3238 // one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3239 if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003240 !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003241 RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
Douglas Gregor836a7e82010-08-11 02:15:33 +00003242 if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3243 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3244 AllowExplicit))
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003245 return ICS;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003246 }
3247 }
3248
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003249 // -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3250 // non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003251 // shall be an rvalue reference.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003252 //
Douglas Gregor870f3742010-04-18 09:22:00 +00003253 // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3254 // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3255 // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3256 // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3257 // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3258 // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3259 // qualifier.
Sebastian Redld92badf2010-06-30 18:13:39 +00003260 // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3261 // go together.
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003262 if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003263 return ICS;
3264
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003265 // -- If the initializer expression
3266 //
3267 // -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
3268 // lvalue and "cv1T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
3269 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3270 (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3271 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3272 (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3273 ICS.setStandard();
3274 ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003275 ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003276 : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3277 : ICK_Identity;
3278 ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3279 ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3280 ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3281 ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3282 ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3283 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3284 // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3285 // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3286 // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3287 // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3288 // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003289 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3290 S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003291 (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003292 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3293 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003294 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003295 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003296 ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003297 return ICS;
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003298 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003299
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003300 // -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3301 // reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003302 // an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3303 // "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003304 // "cv3 T3",
3305 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003306 // then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003307 // expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003308 // in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003309 // class subobject).
3310 if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003311 T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003312 FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3313 Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3314 AllowExplicit)) {
3315 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3316 // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3317 // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3318 // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003319 if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
Douglas Gregorf143cd52011-01-24 16:14:37 +00003320 ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3321 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3322
Douglas Gregor95273c32011-01-21 16:36:05 +00003323 return ICS;
Rafael Espindolabe468d92011-01-22 15:32:35 +00003324 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003325
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003326 // -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3327 // initialized from the initializer expression using the
3328 // rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3329 // reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3330 // reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3331 // cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3332 // cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3333 if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3334 // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3335 // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3336 // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3337 // initialization fails.
3338 return ICS;
3339 }
3340
3341 // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3342 // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3343 // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3344 // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3345 // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3346 if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3347 (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3348 return ICS;
3349
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003350 // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3351 // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3352 if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3353 isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3354 return ICS;
3355
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003356 // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003357 // When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3358 // an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3359 // required to convert the argument expression to the
3360 // underlying type of the reference according to
3361 // 13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3362 // to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3363 // the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3364 // cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3365 // and does not constitute a conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003366 ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3367 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003368 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3369 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003370
3371 // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3372 if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3373 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003374 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3375 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3376 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003377 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003378 } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3379 ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003380 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3381 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3382 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003383 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003384 }
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00003385
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003386 return ICS;
3387}
3388
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003389/// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3390/// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3391/// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3392/// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003393/// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
Douglas Gregore81335c2010-04-16 18:00:29 +00003394/// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003395static ImplicitConversionSequence
3396TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003397 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003398 bool InOverloadResolution) {
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003399 if (ToType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003400 return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003401 /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3402 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00003403 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
Douglas Gregor38ae6ab2010-04-13 16:31:36 +00003404
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003405 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3406 SuppressUserConversions,
3407 /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003408 InOverloadResolution,
3409 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor8e1cf602008-10-29 00:13:59 +00003410}
3411
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003412/// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3413/// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3414/// expression @p From.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003415static ImplicitConversionSequence
3416TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003417 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003418 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3419 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3420 QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
Sebastian Redl931e0bd2009-11-18 20:55:52 +00003421 // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3422 // const volatile object.
3423 unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3424 Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003425 QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003426
3427 // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3428 // to exit early.
3429 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003430
3431 // We need to have an object of class type.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00003432 QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003433 if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003434 FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3435
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003436 // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3437 // better have an lvalue.
3438 assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3439 }
3440
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003441 assert(FromType->isRecordType());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003442
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003443 // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003444 // For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003445 // parameter is
3446 //
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003447 // - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3448 // ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3449 // - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003450 // ref-qualifier
3451 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003452 // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003453 // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3454 //
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003455 // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003456 // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003457 // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3458 // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3459 // non-constant references.
3460
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003461 // First check the qualifiers.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003462 QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003463 if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003464 != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003465 !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003466 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3467 OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003468 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003469 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003470
3471 // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3472 // affects the conversion rank.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003473 QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003474 ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3475 if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3476 SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003477 } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003478 SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003479 else {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003480 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3481 FromType, ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003482 return ICS;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003483 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003484
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003485 // Check the ref-qualifier.
3486 switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3487 case RQ_None:
3488 // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3489 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003490
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003491 case RQ_LValue:
3492 if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3493 // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003494 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003495 ImplicitParamType);
3496 return ICS;
3497 }
3498 break;
3499
3500 case RQ_RValue:
3501 if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3502 // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003503 ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003504 ImplicitParamType);
3505 return ICS;
3506 }
3507 break;
3508 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003509
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003510 // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003511 ICS.setStandard();
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00003512 ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3513 ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003514 ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00003515 ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003516 ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3517 ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003518 ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
Douglas Gregore696ebb2011-01-26 14:52:12 +00003519 ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
Douglas Gregore1a47c12011-01-26 19:41:18 +00003520 ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
3521 ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
3522 = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003523 return ICS;
3524}
3525
3526/// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
3527/// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
3528/// expression.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003529ExprResult
3530Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003531 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003532 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003533 CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003534 QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003535 QualType ImplicitParamRecordType =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003536 Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003537
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003538 Expr::Classification FromClassification;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003539 if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003540 FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
3541 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003542 FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003543 } else {
3544 FromRecordType = From->getType();
3545 DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003546 FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003547 }
3548
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003549 // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
3550 // the actual argument initialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003551 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003552 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
3553 Method, Method->getParent());
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003554 if (ICS.isBad()) {
3555 if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
3556 Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
3557 Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
3558 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
3559 if (CVR) {
3560 Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3561 diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
3562 << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
3563 << From->getSourceRange();
3564 Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3565 << Method->getDeclName();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003566 return ExprError();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003567 }
3568 }
3569
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003570 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00003571 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
Anders Carlssonbfdea0f2009-05-01 18:34:30 +00003572 << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9813d322010-11-16 08:04:45 +00003573 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003574
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003575 if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3576 ExprResult FromRes =
3577 PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
3578 if (FromRes.isInvalid())
3579 return ExprError();
3580 From = FromRes.take();
3581 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003582
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00003583 if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003584 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
3585 From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
3586 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003587}
3588
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003589/// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
3590/// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003591static ImplicitConversionSequence
3592TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
Douglas Gregor0bbe94d2010-05-08 22:41:50 +00003593 // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003594 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
Anders Carlssonef4c7212009-08-27 17:24:15 +00003595 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3596 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003597 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003598 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3599 /*CStyle=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003600}
3601
3602/// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
3603/// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003604ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003605 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003606 if (!ICS.isBad())
3607 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003608
Fariborz Jahanian76197412009-11-18 18:26:29 +00003609 if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
Fariborz Jahanianf0647a52009-09-22 20:24:30 +00003610 return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3611 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
3612 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003613 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003614}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003615
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003616/// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Attempt to contextually convert the
3617/// expression From to 'id'.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003618static ImplicitConversionSequence
3619TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
3620 QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
3621 return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
3622 // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
3623 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
3624 /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
Douglas Gregor58281352011-01-27 00:58:17 +00003625 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3626 /*CStyle=*/false);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003627}
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003628
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003629/// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId - Perform a contextual conversion
3630/// of the expression From to 'id'.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003631ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCId(Expr *From) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003632 QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00003633 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToObjCId(*this, From);
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003634 if (!ICS.isBad())
3635 return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00003636 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahaniancac49a82010-05-12 23:29:11 +00003637}
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00003638
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003639/// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003640/// enumeration type.
3641///
3642/// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
3643/// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
3644/// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3645///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003646/// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
3647/// conversion.
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003648///
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003649/// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
3650///
3651/// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
3652/// have integral or enumeration type.
3653///
3654/// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
3655/// incomplete class type.
3656///
3657/// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
3658/// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
3659/// were available). This is a recovery mode.
3660///
3661/// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
3662/// showing which conversion was picked.
3663///
3664/// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
3665/// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
3666///
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003667/// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003668/// usable conversion function.
3669///
3670/// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
3671/// function, which may be an extension in this case.
3672///
3673/// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
3674/// successful.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003675ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003676Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003677 const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
3678 const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
3679 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
3680 const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
3681 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003682 const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
3683 const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003684 // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
3685 if (From->isTypeDependent())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003686 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003687
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003688 // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
3689 QualType T = From->getType();
3690 if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003691 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003692
3693 // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
3694
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003695 // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003696 // expression of integral or enumeration type.
3697 const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
3698 if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
3699 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3700 << T << From->getSourceRange();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003701 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003702 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003703
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003704 // We must have a complete class type.
3705 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003706 return Owned(From);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003707
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003708 // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
3709 UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
3710 UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
3711 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3712 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003713
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003714 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003715 E = Conversions->end();
3716 I != E;
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003717 ++I) {
3718 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3719 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
3720 if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3721 ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
3722 if (Conversion->isExplicit())
3723 ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3724 else
3725 ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
3726 }
3727 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003728
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003729 switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
3730 case 0:
3731 if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
3732 DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
3733 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3734 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003735
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003736 // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
3737 // conversion; use it.
3738 QualType ConvTy
3739 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3740 std::string TypeStr;
3741 ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, Context.PrintingPolicy);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003742
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003743 Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
3744 << T << ConvTy
3745 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
3746 "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
3747 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
3748 ")");
3749 Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
3750 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003751
3752 // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003753 // explicit conversion function.
3754 if (isSFINAEContext())
3755 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003756
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003757 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003758 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion);
3759 if (Result.isInvalid())
3760 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003761
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003762 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003763 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003764
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003765 // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
3766 break;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003767
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003768 case 1: {
3769 // Apply this conversion.
3770 DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
3771 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003772
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003773 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3774 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
3775 QualType ConvTy
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003776 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003777 if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
3778 if (isSFINAEContext())
3779 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003780
Douglas Gregor4799d032010-06-30 00:20:43 +00003781 Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
3782 << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
3783 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003784
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003785 ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found,
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003786 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003787 if (Result.isInvalid())
3788 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003789
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00003790 From = Result.get();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003791 break;
3792 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003793
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003794 default:
3795 Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
3796 << T << From->getSourceRange();
3797 for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
3798 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
3799 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
3800 QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
3801 Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
3802 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
3803 }
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003804 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003805 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003806
Douglas Gregor5823da32010-06-29 23:25:20 +00003807 if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003808 Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
3809 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003810
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003811 return Owned(From);
Douglas Gregorf4ea7252010-06-29 23:17:37 +00003812}
3813
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003814/// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003815/// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments. If
3816/// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
3817/// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003818///
3819/// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
3820/// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
3821/// code completion.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003822void
3823Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003824 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003825 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor2fe98832008-11-03 19:09:14 +00003826 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Sebastian Redl42e92c42009-04-12 17:16:29 +00003827 bool SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003828 bool PartialOverloading) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003829 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003830 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003831 assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003832 assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
NAKAMURA Takumi7c288862011-01-27 07:09:49 +00003833 "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003834
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003835 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003836 if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
3837 // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
3838 // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
3839 // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
3840 // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003841 // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
3842 // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
3843 // is irrelevant.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003844 AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003845 QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003846 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003847 SuppressUserConversions);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00003848 return;
3849 }
3850 // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
3851 // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003852 }
3853
Douglas Gregorff7028a2009-11-13 23:59:09 +00003854 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003855 return;
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003856
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003857 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00003858 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00003859
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003860 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
3861 // C++ [class.copy]p3:
3862 // A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
3863 // of a class object to an object of its class type.
3864 QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003865 if (NumArgs == 1 &&
Douglas Gregorbd6b17f2010-11-08 17:16:59 +00003866 Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
Douglas Gregor901e7172010-02-21 18:30:38 +00003867 (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
3868 IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
Douglas Gregorffe14e32009-11-14 01:20:54 +00003869 return;
3870 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003871
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003872 // Add this candidate
3873 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
3874 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003875 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003876 Candidate.Function = Function;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003877 Candidate.Viable = true;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00003878 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003879 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00003880 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003881
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003882 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3883
3884 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
3885 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
3886 // list (8.3.5).
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003887 if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
Douglas Gregor2a920012009-09-23 14:56:09 +00003888 !Proto->isVariadic()) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003889 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003890 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003891 return;
3892 }
3893
3894 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
3895 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
3896 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
3897 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
3898 // exactly m parameters.
3899 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00003900 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003901 // Not enough arguments.
3902 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003903 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003904 return;
3905 }
3906
3907 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
3908 // arguments.
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003909 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
3910 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
3911 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
3912 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
3913 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
3914 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
3915 // parameter of F.
3916 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003917 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00003918 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003919 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00003920 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003921 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
3922 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00003923 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003924 break;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00003925 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003926 } else {
3927 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
3928 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
3929 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00003930 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003931 }
3932 }
3933}
3934
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003935/// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
3936/// the overload canddiate set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003937void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003938 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3939 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
3940 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00003941 for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003942 NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
3943 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003944 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003945 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003946 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003947 Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003948 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003949 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3950 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003951 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003952 SuppressUserConversions);
3953 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003954 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003955 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3956 !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003957 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003958 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003959 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003960 Args[0]->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003961 Args[0]->Classify(Context),
3962 Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003963 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003964 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003965 else
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003966 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00003967 /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00003968 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
3969 SuppressUserConversions);
3970 }
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00003971 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00003972}
3973
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003974/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
3975/// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003976void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003977 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003978 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003979 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3980 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003981 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003982 NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00003983 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003984
3985 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
3986 Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00003987
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003988 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
3989 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
3990 "Expected a member function template");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003991 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3992 /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003993 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003994 CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003995 SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00003996 } else {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00003997 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00003998 ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00003999 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004000 }
4001}
4002
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004003/// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4004/// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4005/// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4006/// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4007/// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4008/// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004009/// operators.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004010void
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004011Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004012 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004013 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004014 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004015 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004016 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004017 const FunctionProtoType* Proto
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004018 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004019 assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004020 assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4021 "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004022
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004023 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4024 return;
4025
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004026 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004027 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004028
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004029 // Add this candidate
4030 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4031 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004032 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004033 Candidate.Function = Method;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004034 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004035 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004036 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004037
4038 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4039
4040 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4041 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4042 // list (8.3.5).
4043 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4044 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004045 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004046 return;
4047 }
4048
4049 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4050 // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4051 // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4052 // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4053 // exactly m parameters.
4054 unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4055 if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4056 // Not enough arguments.
4057 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004058 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004059 return;
4060 }
4061
4062 Candidate.Viable = true;
4063 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4064
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004065 if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004066 // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4067 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4068 else {
4069 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4070 // parameter.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004071 Candidate.Conversions[0]
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004072 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4073 Method, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004074 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004075 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004076 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004077 return;
4078 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004079 }
4080
4081 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4082 // arguments.
4083 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4084 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4085 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4086 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4087 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4088 // parameter of F.
4089 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004090 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004091 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004092 SuppressUserConversions,
Anders Carlsson228eea32009-08-28 15:33:32 +00004093 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004094 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004095 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004096 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004097 break;
4098 }
4099 } else {
4100 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4101 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4102 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004103 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004104 }
4105 }
4106}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004107
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004108/// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4109/// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4110/// function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004111void
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004112Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004113 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004114 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004115 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004116 QualType ObjectType,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004117 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004118 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004119 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004120 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004121 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4122 return;
4123
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004124 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004125 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004126 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004127 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004128 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4129 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4130 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4131 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4132 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004133 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004134 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4135 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004136 = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004137 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004138 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4139 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4140 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4141 Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4142 Candidate.Viable = false;
4143 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4144 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4145 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004146 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004147 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004148 Info);
4149 return;
4150 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004151
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004152 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4153 // deduction as a candidate.
4154 assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004155 assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004156 "Specialization is not a member function?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004157 AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004158 ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4159 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00004160}
4161
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004162/// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4163/// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4164/// an appropriate function template specialization.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004165void
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004166Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004167 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00004168 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004169 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4170 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004171 bool SuppressUserConversions) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004172 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4173 return;
4174
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004175 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004176 // In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004177 // function template specializations are generated using template argument
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004178 // deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004179 // candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4180 // or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4181 // functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4182 // function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4183 // functions.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004184 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004185 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4186 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00004187 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004188 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004189 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4190 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004191 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004192 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4193 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004194 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00004195 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4196 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004197 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004198 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004199 Info);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004200 return;
4201 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004202
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004203 // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4204 // deduction as a candidate.
4205 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004206 AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorf1e46692010-04-16 17:33:27 +00004207 SuppressUserConversions);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00004208}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004209
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004210/// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004211/// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004212/// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004213/// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004214/// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4215/// conversion function produces).
4216void
4217Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004218 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004219 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004220 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4221 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004222 assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4223 "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004224 QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004225 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4226 return;
4227
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004228 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004229 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004230
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004231 // Add this candidate
4232 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4233 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004234 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004235 Candidate.Function = Conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004236 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004237 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004238 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
Douglas Gregor5ab11652010-04-17 22:01:05 +00004239 Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
Douglas Gregor3edc4d52010-01-27 03:51:04 +00004240 Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004241 Candidate.Viable = true;
4242 Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004243 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004244
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004245 // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004246 // For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4247 // the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
Douglas Gregor6affc782010-08-19 15:37:02 +00004248 // defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004249 //
4250 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4251 // object parameter.
4252 QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4253 if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4254 ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4255 CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4256 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004257
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004258 Candidate.Conversions[0]
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004259 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4260 From->Classify(Context),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004261 Conversion, ConversionContext);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004262
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004263 if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004264 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004265 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004266 return;
4267 }
Douglas Gregorc9ed4682010-08-19 15:57:50 +00004268
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004269 // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004270 // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4271 // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4272 QualType FromCanon
4273 = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4274 QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4275 if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4276 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004277 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
Fariborz Jahanian996a6aa2009-10-19 19:18:20 +00004278 return;
4279 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004280
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004281 // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4282 // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4283 // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4284 // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4285 // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4286 // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4287 // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4288 // well-formed.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004289 DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004290 VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004291 ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4292 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004293 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00004294 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004295
Douglas Gregor72ebdab2010-11-13 19:36:57 +00004296 QualType CallResultType
4297 = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4298 if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), CallResultType, 0)) {
4299 Candidate.Viable = false;
4300 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4301 return;
4302 }
4303
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004304 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(Conversion->getConversionType());
4305
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004306 // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00004307 // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4308 // allocator).
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00004309 CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
Douglas Gregore8f080122009-11-17 21:16:22 +00004310 From->getLocStart());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004311 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004312 TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004313 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004314 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004315
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004316 switch (ICS.getKind()) {
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004317 case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4318 Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004319
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004320 // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4321 // If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004322 // conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00004323 // shall have exact match rank.
4324 if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4325 GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4326 Candidate.Viable = false;
4327 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4328 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004329
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004330 // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4331 // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4332 // the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4333 // conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4334 // program is ill-formed.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004335 if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
Douglas Gregorcba72b12011-01-21 05:18:22 +00004336 ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4337 Candidate.Viable = false;
4338 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4339 }
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004340 break;
4341
4342 case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4343 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004344 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004345 break;
4346
4347 default:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004348 assert(false &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00004349 "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4350 }
4351}
4352
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004353/// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4354/// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4355/// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4356/// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4357/// [temp.deduct.conv]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004358void
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004359Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004360 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004361 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004362 Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4363 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4364 assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4365 "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4366
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004367 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4368 return;
4369
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00004370 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004371 CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4372 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004373 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004374 Specialization, Info)) {
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004375 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4376 OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4377 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4378 Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4379 Candidate.Viable = false;
4380 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4381 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4382 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004383 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004384 Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
Douglas Gregor90cf2c92010-05-08 20:18:54 +00004385 Info);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004386 return;
4387 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004388
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004389 // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4390 // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4391 assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004392 AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
John McCallb89836b2010-01-26 01:37:31 +00004393 CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004394}
4395
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004396/// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4397/// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4398/// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4399/// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4400/// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4401void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004402 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004403 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004404 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004405 Expr *Object,
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00004406 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004407 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregor5b0f2a22009-09-28 04:47:19 +00004408 if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4409 return;
4410
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004411 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004412 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004413
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004414 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4415 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004416 Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004417 Candidate.Function = 0;
4418 Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4419 Candidate.Viable = true;
4420 Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004421 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004422 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004423 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004424
4425 // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4426 // object parameter.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004427 ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004428 = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004429 Object->Classify(Context),
4430 Conversion, ActingContext);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004431 if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004432 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004433 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00004434 Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004435 return;
4436 }
4437
4438 // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4439 // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4440 // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004441 Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004442 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
Fariborz Jahanian55824512009-11-06 00:23:08 +00004443 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004444 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004445 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction
Douglas Gregor2bbfba02011-01-20 01:32:05 +00004446 = FoundDecl.getDecl();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004447 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004448 = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4449 Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4450
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004451 // Find the
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004452 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4453
4454 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4455 // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4456 // list (8.3.5).
4457 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4458 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004459 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004460 return;
4461 }
4462
4463 // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4464 // we have enough arguments.
4465 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
4466 // Not enough arguments.
4467 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004468 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004469 return;
4470 }
4471
4472 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4473 // arguments.
4474 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4475 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4476 // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4477 // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4478 // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4479 // parameter of F.
4480 QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004481 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004482 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004483 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004484 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004485 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004486 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004487 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004488 break;
4489 }
4490 } else {
4491 // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4492 // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4493 // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004494 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00004495 }
4496 }
4497}
4498
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00004499/// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
4500/// member functions.
4501///
4502/// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
4503/// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
4504/// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
4505/// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
4506/// [over.match.oper]).
4507void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
4508 SourceLocation OpLoc,
4509 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4510 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4511 SourceRange OpRange) {
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004512 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
4513
4514 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
4515 // For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
4516 // cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
4517 // a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
4518 // a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
4519 // three sets of candidate functions, designated member
4520 // candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
4521 // constructed as follows:
4522 QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004523
4524 // -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
4525 // result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
4526 // (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
4527 // empty.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004528 if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004529 // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004530 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004531 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004532
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00004533 LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
4534 LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
4535 Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
4536
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004537 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
Douglas Gregor6a1f9652009-08-27 23:35:55 +00004538 OperEnd = Operators.end();
4539 Oper != OperEnd;
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004540 ++Oper)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004541 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004542 Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00004543 CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00004544 /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004545 }
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004546}
4547
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004548/// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
4549/// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
4550/// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004551/// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
4552/// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004553/// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
4554/// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
4555/// converted to bool.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004556void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004557 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004558 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004559 bool IsAssignmentOperator,
4560 unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004561 // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00004562 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
Douglas Gregor27381f32009-11-23 12:27:39 +00004563
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004564 // Add this candidate
4565 CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4566 OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00004567 Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004568 Candidate.Function = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d248c52008-12-12 02:00:36 +00004569 Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004570 Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004571 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
4572 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
4573 Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
4574
4575 // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4576 // arguments.
4577 Candidate.Viable = true;
4578 Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00004579 Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004580 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004581 // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
4582 // For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
4583 // left operand are restricted as follows:
4584 // -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
4585 // -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
4586 // operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004587 // parameter of a built-in candidate.
Douglas Gregorc5e61072009-01-13 00:52:54 +00004588 //
4589 // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
4590 // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
4591 // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
4592 // is not of the same type.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004593 if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004594 assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004595 "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00004596 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4597 = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004598 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004599 Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00004600 = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
Anders Carlsson03068aa2009-08-27 17:18:13 +00004601 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
Anders Carlsson20d13322009-08-27 17:37:39 +00004602 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false);
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004603 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00004604 if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004605 Candidate.Viable = false;
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00004606 Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
Douglas Gregor436424c2008-11-18 23:14:02 +00004607 break;
4608 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004609 }
4610}
4611
4612/// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
4613/// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
4614/// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
4615/// enumeration types.
4616class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet {
4617 /// TypeSet - A set of types.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004618 typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004619
4620 /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
4621 /// built-in candidates.
4622 TypeSet PointerTypes;
4623
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004624 /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
4625 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4626 TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
4627
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004628 /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
4629 /// used in the built-in candidates.
4630 TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
4631
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004632 /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004633 /// candidates.
4634 TypeSet VectorTypes;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004635
4636 /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
4637 bool HasNonRecordTypes;
4638
4639 /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
4640 /// were present in the candidate set.
4641 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
4642
Douglas Gregor8a2e6012009-08-24 15:23:48 +00004643 /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
4644 /// candidate type set.
4645 Sema &SemaRef;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004646
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004647 /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
4648 ASTContext &Context;
4649
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004650 bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4651 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004652 bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004653
4654public:
4655 /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004656 typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004657
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004658 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004659 : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
4660 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
4661 SemaRef(SemaRef),
4662 Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004663
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004664 void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004665 SourceLocation Loc,
4666 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004667 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4668 const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004669
4670 /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
4671 iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
4672
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004673 /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004674 iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
4675
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004676 /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
4677 iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
4678
4679 /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
4680 iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
4681
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004682 /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
4683 iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
4684
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004685 /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004686 iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004687
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004688 iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
4689 iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004690
4691 bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
4692 bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004693};
4694
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004695/// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004696/// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4697/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4698/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4699/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4700/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4701/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004702///
4703/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004704bool
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004705BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
4706 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004707
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004708 // Insert this type.
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004709 if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004710 return false;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004711
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004712 QualType PointeeTy;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004713 const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004714 bool buildObjCPtr = false;
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004715 if (!PointerTy) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004716 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004717 PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004718 buildObjCPtr = true;
4719 }
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004720 else
4721 assert(false && "type was not a pointer type!");
4722 }
4723 else
4724 PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004725
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004726 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4727 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4728 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4729 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4730 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4731 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004732 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor4ef1d402009-11-09 22:08:55 +00004733 if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
Fariborz Jahanianfacfdd42009-11-09 21:02:05 +00004734 BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004735 bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
4736 bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004737
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004738 // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
4739 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4740 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004741 // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
4742 // in the types.
4743 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
4744 if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004745 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Fariborz Jahanianf2afc802010-08-21 17:11:09 +00004746 if (!buildObjCPtr)
4747 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
4748 else
4749 PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004750 }
4751
4752 return true;
4753}
4754
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004755/// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
4756/// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
4757/// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
4758/// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
4759/// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
4760/// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
4761/// false otherwise.
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004762///
4763/// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004764bool
4765BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
4766 QualType Ty) {
4767 // Insert this type.
4768 if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
4769 return false;
4770
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004771 const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
4772 assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004773
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004774 QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl4990a632009-11-18 20:39:26 +00004775 // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
4776 // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
4777 // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
4778 // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
4779 if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
4780 return true;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004781 const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
4782
4783 // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
4784 // qualifiers.
4785 unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
4786 for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
4787 if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004788
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004789 QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00004790 MemberPointerTypes.insert(
4791 Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004792 }
4793
4794 return true;
4795}
4796
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004797/// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
4798/// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004799/// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
4800/// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004801/// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
4802/// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
4803/// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
4804/// type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004805void
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004806BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00004807 SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor5fb53972009-01-14 15:45:31 +00004808 bool AllowUserConversions,
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004809 bool AllowExplicitConversions,
4810 const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004811 // Only deal with canonical types.
4812 Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
4813
4814 // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
4815 // expression for the purposes of conversions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004816 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004817 Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
4818
John McCall33ddac02011-01-19 10:06:00 +00004819 // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
4820 if (Ty->isArrayType())
4821 Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
4822
4823 // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004824 Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004825
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004826 // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
4827 const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
4828 HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
4829
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004830 // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
4831 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
4832 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
4833
Fariborz Jahaniane4151b52010-08-21 00:10:36 +00004834 if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
4835 PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
4836 else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004837 // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
4838 // of types.
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004839 if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004840 return;
Sebastian Redl8ce189f2009-04-19 21:53:20 +00004841 } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
4842 // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
4843 if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
4844 return;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004845 } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004846 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Chris Lattnera59a3e22009-03-29 00:04:01 +00004847 EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004848 } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004849 // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
4850 // extension.
4851 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00004852 VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004853 } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
4854 // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
4855 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
4856 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004857
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004858 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
4859 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4860 = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4861 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4862 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
4863 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4864 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4865 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004866
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004867 // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
4868 // about which builtin types we can convert to.
4869 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
4870 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00004871
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004872 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4873 if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
4874 AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
4875 VisibleQuals);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00004876 }
4877 }
4878 }
4879}
4880
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004881/// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
4882/// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
4883/// given type to the candidate set.
4884static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
4885 QualType T,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004886 Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004887 unsigned NumArgs,
4888 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4889 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004890
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004891 // T& operator=(T&, T)
4892 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
4893 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4894 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
4895 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004896
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004897 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
4898 // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004899 ParamTypes[0]
4900 = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004901 ParamTypes[1] = T;
4902 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004903 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00004904 }
4905}
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004906
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004907/// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
4908/// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004909static Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
4910 Qualifiers VRQuals;
4911 const RecordType *TyRec;
4912 if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
4913 ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
Douglas Gregord0ace022010-04-25 00:55:24 +00004914 TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004915 else
4916 TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
4917 if (!TyRec) {
Fariborz Jahanianb06ec052009-10-16 22:08:05 +00004918 // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004919 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4920 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4921 return VRQuals;
4922 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004923
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004924 CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
John McCall67da35c2010-02-04 22:26:26 +00004925 if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
4926 return VRQuals;
4927
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004928 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
Sebastian Redl1054fae2009-10-25 17:03:50 +00004929 ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004930
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00004931 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00004932 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallda4458e2010-03-31 01:36:47 +00004933 NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
4934 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4935 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4936 if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004937 QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
4938 if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
4939 CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
4940 // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
4941 // as see them.
4942 bool done = false;
4943 while (!done) {
4944 if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
4945 CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00004946 else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00004947 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
4948 CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
4949 else
4950 done = true;
4951 if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
4952 VRQuals.addVolatile();
4953 if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
4954 VRQuals.addRestrict();
4955 if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
4956 return VRQuals;
4957 }
4958 }
4959 }
4960 return VRQuals;
4961}
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004962
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004963namespace {
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004964
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004965/// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
4966/// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
4967/// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
4968/// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
4969class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004970 // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
4971 Sema &S;
4972 Expr **Args;
4973 unsigned NumArgs;
4974 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00004975 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004976 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
4977 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00004978
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004979 // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
4980 // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004981 // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
4982 // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00004983 static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
4984 static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
4985 static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
4986 LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
4987 static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
4988 LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
4989 static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
4990
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00004991 /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
4992 CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
4993 assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
4994 static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
4995 ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
4996 // Start of promoted types.
4997 &ASTContext::FloatTy,
4998 &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
4999 &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
John McCall52872982010-11-13 05:51:15 +00005000
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005001 // Start of integral types.
5002 &ASTContext::IntTy,
5003 &ASTContext::LongTy,
5004 &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5005 &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5006 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5007 &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5008 // End of promoted types.
5009
5010 &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5011 &ASTContext::CharTy,
5012 &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5013 &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5014 &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5015 &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5016 &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5017 &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5018 &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5019 // End of integral types.
5020 // FIXME: What about complex?
5021 };
5022 return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5023 }
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005024
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005025 /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5026 /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5027 CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5028 // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5029 // The rules are basically:
5030 // - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5031 // - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5032 // - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5033 // - use the larger type
5034 // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5035 // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5036 // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5037 // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5038 // better not to make any assumptions).
5039 enum PromotedType {
5040 Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL, Dep=-1
5041 };
5042 static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5043 [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5044 /* Flt*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt, Flt },
5045 /* Dbl*/ { Dbl, Dbl, LDbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl, Dbl },
5046 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5047 /* SI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SI, SL, SLL, UI, UL, ULL },
5048 /* SL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SL, SL, SLL, Dep, UL, ULL },
5049 /* SLL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, SLL, SLL, SLL, Dep, Dep, ULL },
5050 /* UI*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UI, Dep, Dep, UI, UL, ULL },
5051 /* UL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, UL, UL, Dep, UL, UL, ULL },
5052 /* ULL*/ { Flt, Dbl, LDbl, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL, ULL },
5053 };
5054
5055 assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5056 assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5057 int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5058
5059 // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005060 if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005061
5062 // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5063 // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005064 CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5065 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005066 unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5067 RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5068
5069 // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5070 if (LW > RW) return LT;
5071 else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5072
5073 // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5074 if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5075 assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5076 return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5077 }
5078
Chandler Carruth5659c0c2010-12-12 09:22:45 +00005079 /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5080 /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005081 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5082 bool HasVolatile) {
5083 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5084 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5085 S.Context.IntTy
5086 };
5087
5088 // Non-volatile version.
5089 if (NumArgs == 1)
5090 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5091 else
5092 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5093
5094 // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5095 // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5096 if (HasVolatile) {
5097 ParamTypes[0] =
5098 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5099 S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5100 if (NumArgs == 1)
5101 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5102 else
5103 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5104 }
5105 }
5106
5107public:
5108 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5109 Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5110 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005111 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005112 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
5113 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5114 : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5115 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005116 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5117 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005118 CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5119 CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5120 // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005121 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005122 "Invalid first promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005123 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5124 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005125 "Invalid last promoted integral type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005126 assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5127 == S.Context.FloatTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005128 "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005129 assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5130 == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005131 "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5132 }
5133
5134 // C++ [over.built]p3:
5135 //
5136 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5137 // is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5138 // functions of the form
5139 //
5140 // VQ T& operator++(VQ T&);
5141 // T operator++(VQ T&, int);
5142 //
5143 // C++ [over.built]p4:
5144 //
5145 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5146 // than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5147 // candidate operator functions of the form
5148 //
5149 // VQ T& operator--(VQ T&);
5150 // T operator--(VQ T&, int);
5151 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005152 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5153 return;
5154
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005155 for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5156 Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5157 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005158 getArithmeticType(Arith),
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005159 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5160 }
5161 }
5162
5163 // C++ [over.built]p5:
5164 //
5165 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5166 // cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5167 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5168 //
5169 // T*VQ& operator++(T*VQ&);
5170 // T*VQ& operator--(T*VQ&);
5171 // T* operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5172 // T* operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5173 void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5174 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5175 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5176 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5177 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5178 // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005179 if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005180 continue;
5181
5182 addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5183 (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5184 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5185 }
5186 }
5187
5188 // C++ [over.built]p6:
5189 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5190 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5191 //
5192 // T& operator*(T*);
5193 //
5194 // C++ [over.built]p7:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005195 // For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005196 // ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005197 // T& operator*(T*);
5198 void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5199 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5200 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5201 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5202 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5203 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5204 QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005205 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5206 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005207
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00005208 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5209 if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5210 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005211
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005212 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5213 &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5214 }
5215 }
5216
5217 // C++ [over.built]p9:
5218 // For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5219 // operator functions of the form
5220 //
5221 // T operator+(T);
5222 // T operator-(T);
5223 void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005224 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5225 return;
5226
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005227 for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5228 Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005229 QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005230 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5231 }
5232
5233 // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5234 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5235 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5236 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5237 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5238 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5239 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5240 }
5241 }
5242
5243 // C++ [over.built]p8:
5244 // For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5245 // the form
5246 //
5247 // T* operator+(T*);
5248 void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5249 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5250 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5251 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5252 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5253 QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5254 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5255 }
5256 }
5257
5258 // C++ [over.built]p10:
5259 // For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5260 // operator functions of the form
5261 //
5262 // T operator~(T);
5263 void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005264 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5265 return;
5266
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005267 for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5268 Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005269 QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005270 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5271 }
5272
5273 // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5274 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5275 Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5276 VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5277 Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5278 QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5279 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5280 }
5281 }
5282
5283 // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5284 // For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5285 // functions of the form
5286 //
5287 // bool operator==(T,T);
5288 // bool operator!=(T,T);
5289 void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5290 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5291 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5292
5293 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5294 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5295 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5296 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5297 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5298 ++MemPtr) {
5299 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5300 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5301 continue;
5302
5303 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5304 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5305 CandidateSet);
5306 }
5307 }
5308 }
5309
5310 // C++ [over.built]p15:
5311 //
5312 // For every pointer or enumeration type T, there exist
5313 // candidate operator functions of the form
5314 //
5315 // bool operator<(T, T);
5316 // bool operator>(T, T);
5317 // bool operator<=(T, T);
5318 // bool operator>=(T, T);
5319 // bool operator==(T, T);
5320 // bool operator!=(T, T);
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005321 void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5322 // C++ [over.built]p1:
5323 // If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5324 // types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5325 // function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5326 // functions.
5327 //
5328 // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5329 // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5330 // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5331 // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5332 // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5333 // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5334 // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5335 llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5336 UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5337
5338 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5339 if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5340 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5341 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5342 CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5343 C != CEnd; ++C) {
5344 if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5345 continue;
5346
5347 QualType FirstParamType =
5348 C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5349 QualType SecondParamType =
5350 C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5351
5352 // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5353 if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5354 !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5355 continue;
5356
5357 // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5358 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5359 std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5360 S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5361 }
5362 }
5363 }
5364
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005365 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5366 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5367
5368 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5369 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5370 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5371 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5372 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5373 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5374 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5375 continue;
5376
5377 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5378 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5379 CandidateSet);
5380 }
5381 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5382 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5383 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5384 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5385 CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5386
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005387 // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5388 // candidate exists.
5389 if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5390 UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5391 CanonType)))
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005392 continue;
5393
5394 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00005395 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5396 CandidateSet);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005397 }
5398 }
5399 }
5400
5401 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5402 //
5403 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5404 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5405 //
5406 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5407 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t); [BELOW]
5408 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5409 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5410 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*); [BELOW]
5411 //
5412 // C++ [over.built]p14:
5413 //
5414 // For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5415 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5416 //
5417 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5418 void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5419 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5420 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5421
5422 for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5423 QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5424 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5425 S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5426 };
5427 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5428 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5429 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5430 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005431 QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5432 if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5433 continue;
5434
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005435 AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5436 if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5437 // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5438 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5439 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5440 CandidateSet);
5441 }
5442 if (Op == OO_Minus) {
5443 // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
5444 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5445 continue;
5446
5447 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5448 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
5449 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5450 }
5451 }
5452 }
5453 }
5454
5455 // C++ [over.built]p12:
5456 //
5457 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
5458 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5459 //
5460 // LR operator*(L, R);
5461 // LR operator/(L, R);
5462 // LR operator+(L, R);
5463 // LR operator-(L, R);
5464 // bool operator<(L, R);
5465 // bool operator>(L, R);
5466 // bool operator<=(L, R);
5467 // bool operator>=(L, R);
5468 // bool operator==(L, R);
5469 // bool operator!=(L, R);
5470 //
5471 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5472 // between types L and R.
5473 //
5474 // C++ [over.built]p24:
5475 //
5476 // For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
5477 // candidate operator functions of the form
5478 //
5479 // LR operator?(bool, L, R);
5480 //
5481 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5482 // between types L and R.
5483 // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
5484 void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005485 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5486 return;
5487
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005488 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5489 Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
5490 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5491 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005492 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5493 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005494 QualType Result =
5495 isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005496 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005497 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5498 }
5499 }
5500
5501 // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
5502 // conditional operator for vector types.
5503 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5504 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5505 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5506 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5507 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5508 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5509 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5510 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5511 QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
5512 QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
5513 if (!isComparison) {
5514 if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
5515 Result = *Vec1;
5516 else
5517 Result = *Vec2;
5518 }
5519
5520 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5521 }
5522 }
5523 }
5524
5525 // C++ [over.built]p17:
5526 //
5527 // For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
5528 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5529 //
5530 // LR operator%(L, R);
5531 // LR operator&(L, R);
5532 // LR operator^(L, R);
5533 // LR operator|(L, R);
5534 // L operator<<(L, R);
5535 // L operator>>(L, R);
5536 //
5537 // where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
5538 // between types L and R.
5539 void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005540 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5541 return;
5542
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005543 for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5544 Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
5545 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5546 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005547 QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
5548 getArithmeticType(Right) };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005549 QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
5550 ? LandR[0]
Chandler Carruth3b35b78d2010-12-12 09:59:53 +00005551 : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005552 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5553 }
5554 }
5555 }
5556
5557 // C++ [over.built]p20:
5558 //
5559 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
5560 // pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
5561 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5562 //
5563 // VQ T& operator=(VQ T&, T);
5564 void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5565 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5566 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5567
5568 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5569 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5570 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5571 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5572 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5573 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5574 continue;
5575
5576 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
5577 CandidateSet);
5578 }
5579
5580 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5581 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5582 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5583 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5584 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5585 continue;
5586
5587 AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
5588 CandidateSet);
5589 }
5590 }
5591 }
5592
5593 // C++ [over.built]p19:
5594 //
5595 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
5596 // volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
5597 // of the form
5598 //
5599 // T*VQ& operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
5600 //
5601 // C++ [over.built]p21:
5602 //
5603 // For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5604 // cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
5605 // empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5606 //
5607 // T*VQ& operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5608 // T*VQ& operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
5609 void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
5610 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5611 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5612
5613 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5614 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5615 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5616 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5617 // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
5618 if (isEqualOp)
5619 AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005620 else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5621 continue;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005622
5623 // non-volatile version
5624 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5625 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5626 isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5627 };
5628 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5629 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
5630
5631 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5632 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5633 // volatile version
5634 ParamTypes[0] =
5635 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
5636 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5637 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5638 }
5639 }
5640
5641 if (isEqualOp) {
5642 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5643 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5644 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5645 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5646 // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
5647 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5648 continue;
5649
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005650 QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5651 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
5652 *Ptr,
5653 };
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005654
5655 // non-volatile version
5656 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5657 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
5658
5659 if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5660 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5661 // volatile version
5662 ParamTypes[0] =
5663 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005664 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5665 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005666 }
5667 }
5668 }
5669 }
5670
5671 // C++ [over.built]p18:
5672 //
5673 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
5674 // VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
5675 // arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
5676 // the form
5677 //
5678 // VQ L& operator=(VQ L&, R);
5679 // VQ L& operator*=(VQ L&, R);
5680 // VQ L& operator/=(VQ L&, R);
5681 // VQ L& operator+=(VQ L&, R);
5682 // VQ L& operator-=(VQ L&, R);
5683 void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005684 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5685 return;
5686
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005687 for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
5688 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5689 Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
5690 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005691 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005692
5693 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5694 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005695 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005696 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5697 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5698
5699 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5700 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5701 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005702 S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005703 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005704 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5705 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005706 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5707 }
5708 }
5709 }
5710
5711 // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
5712 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5713 Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5714 Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5715 Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
5716 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5717 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
5718 Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
5719 Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
5720 QualType ParamTypes[2];
5721 ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
5722 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5723 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
5724 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5725 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5726
5727 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
5728 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5729 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
5730 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00005731 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5732 CandidateSet,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005733 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
5734 }
5735 }
5736 }
5737 }
5738
5739 // C++ [over.built]p22:
5740 //
5741 // For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
5742 // is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
5743 // type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5744 //
5745 // VQ L& operator%=(VQ L&, R);
5746 // VQ L& operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
5747 // VQ L& operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
5748 // VQ L& operator&=(VQ L&, R);
5749 // VQ L& operator^=(VQ L&, R);
5750 // VQ L& operator|=(VQ L&, R);
5751 void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005752 if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5753 return;
5754
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005755 for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
5756 for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5757 Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
5758 QualType ParamTypes[2];
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005759 ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005760
5761 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
5762 ParamTypes[0] =
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005763 S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005764 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5765 if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
5766 // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
Chandler Carruthc6586e52010-12-12 10:35:00 +00005767 ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005768 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
5769 ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
5770 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5771 CandidateSet);
5772 }
5773 }
5774 }
5775 }
5776
5777 // C++ [over.operator]p23:
5778 //
5779 // There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
5780 //
5781 // bool operator!(bool);
5782 // bool operator&&(bool, bool);
5783 // bool operator||(bool, bool);
5784 void addExclaimOverload() {
5785 QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
5786 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
5787 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5788 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
5789 }
5790 void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
5791 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
5792 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5793 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
5794 /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
5795 }
5796
5797 // C++ [over.built]p13:
5798 //
5799 // For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
5800 // exist candidate operator functions of the form
5801 //
5802 // T* operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5803 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
5804 // T* operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t); [ABOVE]
5805 // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*); [ABOVE]
5806 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
5807 void addSubscriptOverloads() {
5808 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5809 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5810 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5811 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5812 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
5813 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005814 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5815 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00005816
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005817 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5818
5819 // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
5820 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5821 }
5822
5823 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5824 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
5825 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
5826 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5827 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
5828 QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregor66990032011-01-05 00:13:17 +00005829 if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
5830 continue;
5831
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005832 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
5833
5834 // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
5835 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5836 }
5837 }
5838
5839 // C++ [over.built]p11:
5840 // For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
5841 // C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
5842 // type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
5843 // there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5844 //
5845 // CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
5846 //
5847 // where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
5848 void addArrowStarOverloads() {
5849 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5850 Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5851 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5852 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5853 QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
5854 QualType C1;
5855 QualifierCollector Q1;
5856 C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
5857 if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
5858 continue;
5859 // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
5860 // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
5861 // volatile/restrict type.
5862 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
5863 continue;
5864 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
5865 continue;
5866 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5867 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
5868 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
5869 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5870 const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
5871 QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
5872 C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
5873 if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
5874 break;
5875 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
5876 // build CV12 T&
5877 QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
5878 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
5879 T.isVolatileQualified())
5880 continue;
5881 if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
5882 T.isRestrictQualified())
5883 continue;
5884 T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
5885 QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5886 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5887 }
5888 }
5889 }
5890
5891 // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
5892 // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
5893 // therefore added as binary.
5894 //
5895 // C++ [over.built]p25:
5896 // For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
5897 // enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5898 //
5899 // T operator?(bool, T, T);
5900 //
5901 void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
5902 /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5903 llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5904
5905 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
5906 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5907 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5908 PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5909 Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5910 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5911 continue;
5912
5913 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5914 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5915 }
5916
5917 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5918 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5919 MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5920 MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
5921 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5922 continue;
5923
5924 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5925 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5926 }
5927
5928 if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
5929 for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5930 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5931 EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5932 Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5933 if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
5934 continue;
5935
5936 if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
5937 continue;
5938
5939 QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5940 S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5941 }
5942 }
5943 }
5944 }
5945};
5946
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005947} // end anonymous namespace
5948
5949/// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
5950/// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
5951/// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
5952/// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
5953/// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
5954void
5955Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5956 SourceLocation OpLoc,
5957 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5958 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005959 // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
5960 // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005961 // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
5962 // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
Fariborz Jahanian3b937fa2009-10-15 17:14:05 +00005963 Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
5964 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanianb9e8c422009-10-19 21:30:45 +00005965 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5966 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005967
5968 bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
5969 bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005970 llvm::SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
5971 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5972 CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
5973 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
5974 OpLoc,
5975 true,
5976 (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
5977 Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
5978 Op == OO_PipePipe),
5979 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005980 HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
5981 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
5982 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
5983 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
5984 CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
Douglas Gregorb37c9af2010-11-03 17:00:07 +00005985 }
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005986
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005987 // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
5988 // for any of the arguments to the operator.
5989 if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType)
5990 return;
5991
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005992 // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
5993 BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
5994 VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
Chandler Carruth00a38332010-12-13 01:44:01 +00005995 HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00005996 CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
5997
5998 // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00005999 switch (Op) {
6000 case OO_None:
6001 case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6002 assert(false && "Expected an overloaded operator");
6003 break;
6004
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006005 case OO_New:
6006 case OO_Delete:
6007 case OO_Array_New:
6008 case OO_Array_Delete:
6009 case OO_Call:
6010 assert(false && "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6011 break;
6012
6013 case OO_Comma:
6014 case OO_Arrow:
6015 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6016 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6017 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006018 break;
6019
6020 case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006021 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006022 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth9694b9c2010-12-12 08:41:34 +00006023 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006024
6025 case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006026 if (NumArgs == 1) {
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006027 OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006028 } else {
6029 OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6030 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6031 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006032 break;
6033
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006034 case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006035 if (NumArgs == 1)
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006036 OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6037 else
6038 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6039 break;
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006040
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006041 case OO_Slash:
6042 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006043 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006044
6045 case OO_PlusPlus:
6046 case OO_MinusMinus:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006047 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6048 OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006049 break;
6050
Douglas Gregor84605ae2009-08-24 13:43:27 +00006051 case OO_EqualEqual:
6052 case OO_ExclaimEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006053 OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006054 // Fall through.
Chandler Carruth9de23cd2010-12-12 08:45:02 +00006055
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006056 case OO_Less:
6057 case OO_Greater:
6058 case OO_LessEqual:
6059 case OO_GreaterEqual:
Chandler Carruthc02db8c2010-12-12 09:14:11 +00006060 OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Chandler Carruth0375e952010-12-12 08:32:28 +00006061 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6062 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006063
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006064 case OO_Percent:
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006065 case OO_Caret:
6066 case OO_Pipe:
6067 case OO_LessLess:
6068 case OO_GreaterGreater:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006069 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006070 break;
6071
Chandler Carruth5184de02010-12-12 08:51:33 +00006072 case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6073 if (NumArgs == 1)
6074 // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6075 // -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6076 // operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6077 break;
6078
6079 OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6080 break;
6081
6082 case OO_Tilde:
6083 OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6084 break;
6085
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006086 case OO_Equal:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006087 OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00006088 // Fall through.
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006089
6090 case OO_PlusEqual:
6091 case OO_MinusEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006092 OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006093 // Fall through.
6094
6095 case OO_StarEqual:
6096 case OO_SlashEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006097 OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006098 break;
6099
6100 case OO_PercentEqual:
6101 case OO_LessLessEqual:
6102 case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6103 case OO_AmpEqual:
6104 case OO_CaretEqual:
6105 case OO_PipeEqual:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006106 OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006107 break;
6108
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006109 case OO_Exclaim:
6110 OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006111 break;
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006112
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006113 case OO_AmpAmp:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006114 case OO_PipePipe:
6115 OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006116 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006117
6118 case OO_Subscript:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006119 OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006120 break;
6121
6122 case OO_ArrowStar:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006123 OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006124 break;
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00006125
6126 case OO_Conditional:
Chandler Carruth85c2d09a2010-12-12 08:11:30 +00006127 OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
Chandler Carruthf9802442010-12-12 08:39:38 +00006128 OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6129 break;
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00006130 }
6131}
6132
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006133/// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6134/// to the set of overloading candidates.
6135///
6136/// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6137/// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6138/// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6139/// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006140void
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006141Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006142 bool Operator,
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006143 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00006144 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006145 OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6146 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006147 ADLResult Fns;
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006148
John McCall91f61fc2010-01-26 06:04:06 +00006149 // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6150 // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6151 // which means we need to key off the canonical decl. However,
6152 // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6153 // right set of default arguments. What default arguments are
6154 // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6155
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006156 // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006157 ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns);
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006158
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006159 // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006160 for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6161 CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6162 Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006163 if (Cand->Function) {
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006164 Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006165 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006166 Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006167 }
Douglas Gregord2b7ef62009-03-13 00:33:25 +00006168
6169 // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6170 // set.
John McCall8fe68082010-01-26 07:16:45 +00006171 for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006172 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006173 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00006174 if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006175 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006176
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006177 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00006178 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00006179 } else
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006180 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00006181 FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00006182 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor15448f82009-06-27 21:05:07 +00006183 }
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00006184}
6185
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006186/// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6187/// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006188bool
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006189isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006190 const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6191 const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006192 SourceLocation Loc,
6193 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006194 // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6195 // functions.
6196 if (!Cand2.Viable)
6197 return Cand1.Viable;
6198 else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6199 return false;
6200
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006201 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6202 //
6203 // -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6204 // that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6205 // any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6206 // better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6207 unsigned StartArg = 0;
6208 if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6209 StartArg = 1;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006210
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006211 // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006212 // A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6213 // viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006214 // conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006215 unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6216 assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6217 bool HasBetterConversion = false;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00006218 for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006219 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6220 Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006221 Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6222 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6223 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6224 HasBetterConversion = true;
6225 break;
6226
6227 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6228 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6229 return false;
6230
6231 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6232 // Do nothing.
6233 break;
6234 }
6235 }
6236
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006237 // -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006238 // ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006239 if (HasBetterConversion)
6240 return true;
6241
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006242 // - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006243 // specialization, or, if not that,
Douglas Gregorce21919b2010-06-08 21:03:17 +00006244 if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006245 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6246 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006247
6248 // -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6249 // template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6250 // according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
Douglas Gregord3cb3562009-07-07 23:38:56 +00006251 // if not that,
Douglas Gregor55137cb2009-08-02 23:46:29 +00006252 if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006253 Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006254 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006255 = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6256 Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6257 Loc,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006258 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
Douglas Gregorb837ea42011-01-11 17:34:58 +00006259 : TPOC_Call,
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006260 Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00006261 return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
Douglas Gregor6edd9772011-01-19 23:54:39 +00006262 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006263
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006264 // -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6265 // (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6266 // from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6267 // the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6268 // conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6269 // from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006270 if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006271 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006272 isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006273 switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6274 Cand1.FinalConversion,
Douglas Gregora1f013e2008-11-07 22:36:19 +00006275 Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6276 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6277 // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6278 return true;
6279
6280 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6281 // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6282 return false;
6283
6284 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6285 // Do nothing
6286 break;
6287 }
6288 }
6289
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006290 return false;
6291}
6292
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006293/// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006294/// within an overload candidate set.
6295///
6296/// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6297///
6298/// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6299/// which overload resolution occurs.
6300///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006301/// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00006302/// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6303///
6304/// \returns The result of overload resolution.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006305OverloadingResult
6306OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00006307 iterator &Best,
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00006308 bool UserDefinedConversion) {
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006309 // Find the best viable function.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006310 Best = end();
6311 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6312 if (Cand->Viable)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006313 if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006314 UserDefinedConversion))
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006315 Best = Cand;
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006316 }
6317
6318 // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006319 if (Best == end())
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006320 return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6321
6322 // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6323 // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006324 for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006325 if (Cand->Viable &&
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006326 Cand != Best &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006327 !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
Douglas Gregord5b730c92010-09-12 08:07:23 +00006328 UserDefinedConversion)) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006329 Best = end();
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006330 return OR_Ambiguous;
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00006331 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006332 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006333
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006334 // Best is the best viable function.
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006335 if (Best->Function &&
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006336 (Best->Function->isDeleted() || Best->Function->isUnavailable()))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00006337 return OR_Deleted;
6338
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006339 return OR_Success;
6340}
6341
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006342namespace {
6343
6344enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6345 oc_function,
6346 oc_method,
6347 oc_constructor,
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006348 oc_function_template,
6349 oc_method_template,
6350 oc_constructor_template,
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006351 oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6352 oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006353 oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
6354 oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006355};
6356
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006357OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6358 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6359 std::string &Description) {
6360 bool isTemplate = false;
6361
6362 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6363 isTemplate = true;
6364 Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6365 FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6366 }
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006367
6368 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006369 if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006370 return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006371
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006372 if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6373 return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6374
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006375 return Ctor->isCopyConstructor() ? oc_implicit_copy_constructor
6376 : oc_implicit_default_constructor;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006377 }
6378
6379 if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6380 // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6381 // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006382 if (!Meth->isImplicit())
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006383 return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006384
Douglas Gregorec3bec02010-09-27 22:37:28 +00006385 assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006386 && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006387 return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6388 }
6389
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006390 return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006391}
6392
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006393void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6394 const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6395 if (!Ctor) return;
6396
6397 Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6398 if (!Ctor) return;
6399
6400 S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6401}
6402
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006403} // end anonymous namespace
6404
6405// Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6406void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006407 std::string FnDesc;
6408 OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6409 Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6410 << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006411 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
John McCallfd0b2f82010-01-06 09:43:14 +00006412}
6413
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00006414//Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6415// OverloadedExpr
6416void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6417 assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6418
6419 OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6420 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6421
6422 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6423 IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6424 I != IEnd; ++I) {
6425 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
6426 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6427 NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
6428 } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
6429 = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
6430 NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
6431 }
6432 }
6433}
6434
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006435/// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion. The partial diagnostic is the
6436/// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
6437/// target types of the conversion.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006438void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
6439 Sema &S,
6440 SourceLocation CaretLoc,
6441 const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
6442 S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
6443 << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006444 for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006445 I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6446 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006447 }
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006448}
6449
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006450namespace {
6451
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006452void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
6453 const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
6454 assert(Conv.isBad());
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006455 assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
6456 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6457
6458 // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
6459 // non-constructor method. Note that 'I' corresponds the
6460 // conversion-slot index.
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006461 bool isObjectArgument = false;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006462 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006463 if (I == 0)
6464 isObjectArgument = true;
6465 else
6466 I--;
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006467 }
6468
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006469 std::string FnDesc;
6470 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
6471
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006472 Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
6473 QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
6474 QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006475
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006476 if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006477 assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006478 Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
6479 if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
6480 E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00006481 DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006482
6483 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
6484 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6485 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6486 << ToTy << Name << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006487 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCallfb7ad0f2010-02-02 02:42:52 +00006488 return;
6489 }
6490
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006491 // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
6492 // to a qualifier mismatch.
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006493 CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
6494 CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
6495 if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6496 CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
6497 else {
6498 // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
6499 if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6500 if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6501 CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
6502 }
6503
6504 if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
6505 !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
6506 // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
6507 while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
6508 CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6509 while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
6510 CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
6511
6512 Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
6513 Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
6514
6515 if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
6516 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
6517 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6518 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6519 << FromTy
6520 << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
6521 << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006522 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006523 return;
6524 }
6525
6526 unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
6527 assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
6528
6529 if (isObjectArgument) {
6530 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
6531 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6532 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6533 << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
6534 } else {
6535 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
6536 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6537 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6538 << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
6539 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006540 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006541 return;
6542 }
6543
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006544 // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
6545 // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
6546 // the failure.
6547 QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
6548 if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6549 TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6550 if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
6551 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
6552 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6553 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
6554 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006555 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6d174642010-01-23 08:10:49 +00006556 return;
6557 }
6558
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006559 // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006560 unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006561 if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6562 if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6563 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6564 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6565 !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6566 !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006567 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006568 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006569 BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006570 }
6571 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
6572 = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6573 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
6574 = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6575 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6576 if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
6577 if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
6578 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
6579 FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006580 BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
6581 } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
6582 if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
6583 !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
6584 !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
6585 S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
6586 BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
6587 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006588
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006589 if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006590 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006591 diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006592 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
6593 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
Douglas Gregorfb0c0d32010-07-01 02:14:45 +00006594 << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006595 << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006596 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor56f2e342010-06-30 23:01:39 +00006597 return;
6598 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006599
John McCall47000992010-01-14 03:28:57 +00006600 // TODO: specialize more based on the kind of mismatch
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006601 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv)
6602 << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006603 << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
John McCalla1709fd2010-01-14 00:56:20 +00006604 << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006605 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006606}
6607
6608void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6609 unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
6610 // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
6611
6612 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6613 const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6614
6615 unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006616
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006617 // at least / at most / exactly
6618 unsigned mode, modeCount;
6619 if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006620 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
6621 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6622 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006623 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
Douglas Gregor7825bf32011-01-06 22:09:01 +00006624 FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006625 mode = 0; // "at least"
6626 else
6627 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6628 modeCount = MinParams;
6629 } else {
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006630 assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
6631 (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
6632 Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006633 if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
6634 mode = 1; // "at most"
6635 else
6636 mode = 2; // "exactly"
6637 modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
6638 }
6639
6640 std::string Description;
6641 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
6642
6643 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006644 << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006645 << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006646 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006647}
6648
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006649/// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
6650void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6651 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6652 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
6653
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006654 TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006655 NamedDecl *ParamD;
6656 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
6657 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
6658 (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006659 switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
6660 case Sema::TDK_Success:
6661 llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
6662
6663 case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006664 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
6665 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
6666 << ParamD->getDeclName();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006667 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006668 return;
6669 }
6670
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006671 case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
6672 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
6673 TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
6674
6675 QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
6676
6677 // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
6678 // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006679 QualifierCollector Qs;
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006680 Qs.strip(Param);
John McCall717d9b02010-12-10 11:01:00 +00006681 QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006682 assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
6683
6684 // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
6685 // about that. It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
6686 // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
6687 // done on dependent types).
6688 QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
6689
6690 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
6691 << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006692 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall42d7d192010-08-05 09:05:08 +00006693 return;
6694 }
6695
6696 case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00006697 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006698 int which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006699 if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006700 which = 0;
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006701 else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006702 which = 1;
6703 else {
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006704 which = 2;
6705 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006706
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006707 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006708 << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006709 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
6710 << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006711 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor3626a5c2010-05-08 17:41:32 +00006712 return;
6713 }
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006714
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006715 case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006716 assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006717 if (ParamD->getDeclName())
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006718 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006719 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
6720 << ParamD->getDeclName();
6721 else {
6722 int index = 0;
6723 if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
6724 index = TTP->getIndex();
6725 else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
6726 = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
6727 index = NTTP->getIndex();
6728 else
6729 index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006730 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006731 diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
6732 << (index + 1);
6733 }
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006734 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregor1d72edd2010-05-08 19:15:54 +00006735 return;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006736
Douglas Gregor02eb4832010-05-08 18:13:28 +00006737 case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
6738 case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
6739 DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
6740 return;
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006741
6742 case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
6743 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006744 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006745 return;
6746
6747 case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
6748 std::string ArgString;
6749 if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
6750 = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
6751 ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6752 Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
6753 *Args);
6754 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
6755 << ArgString;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006756 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
Douglas Gregord09efd42010-05-08 20:07:26 +00006757 return;
6758 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006759
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006760 // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
6761 // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006762 case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006763 case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
6764 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006765 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006766 return;
6767 }
6768}
6769
6770/// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate. We've
6771/// already generated a primary error at the call site.
6772///
6773/// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
6774/// pointed at the candidate declaration. Yes, this creates some
6775/// major challenges of technical writing. Yes, this makes pointing
6776/// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward. It's still
6777/// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
6778/// overload.
6779///
6780/// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
6781/// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
6782/// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006783void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6784 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006785 FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
6786
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006787 // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00006788 if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() || Fn->isUnavailable())) {
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006789 std::string FnDesc;
6790 OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
John McCall53262c92010-01-12 02:15:36 +00006791
6792 S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006793 << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006794 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006795 return;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006796 }
6797
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006798 // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
6799 if (Cand->Viable) {
6800 S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
6801 return;
6802 }
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006803
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006804 switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
6805 case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
6806 case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
6807 return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006808
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006809 case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
John McCall8b9ed552010-02-01 18:53:26 +00006810 return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
6811
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006812 case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
6813 case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
Douglas Gregor2c326bc2010-04-12 23:42:09 +00006814 case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006815 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006816
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006817 case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
6818 unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
6819 for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006820 if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
6821 return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00006822
John McCall6a61b522010-01-13 09:16:55 +00006823 // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
6824 // when user-conversion overload fails. Figure out how to handle
6825 // those conditions and diagnose them well.
6826 return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
John McCalle1ac8d12010-01-13 00:25:19 +00006827 }
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006828 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006829}
6830
6831void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6832 // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
6833 // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
6834 // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
6835 QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
6836 bool isLValueReference = false;
6837 bool isRValueReference = false;
6838 bool isPointer = false;
6839 if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6840 FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
6841 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6842 isLValueReference = true;
6843 } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
6844 FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
6845 FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
6846 isRValueReference = true;
6847 }
6848 if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
6849 FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
6850 isPointer = true;
6851 }
6852 // Desugar down to a function type.
6853 FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
6854 // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
6855 if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
6856 if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
6857 if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
6858
6859 S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
6860 << FnType;
Sebastian Redl08905022011-02-05 19:23:19 +00006861 MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006862}
6863
6864void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
6865 const char *Opc,
6866 SourceLocation OpLoc,
6867 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6868 assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
6869 std::string TypeStr("operator");
6870 TypeStr += Opc;
6871 TypeStr += "(";
6872 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
6873 if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
6874 TypeStr += ")";
6875 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6876 } else {
6877 TypeStr += ", ";
6878 TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
6879 TypeStr += ")";
6880 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
6881 }
6882}
6883
6884void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
6885 OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6886 unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
6887 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
6888 const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00006889 if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
6890 if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
6891
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006892 ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006893 S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00006894 }
6895}
6896
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006897SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
6898 if (Cand->Function)
6899 return Cand->Function->getLocation();
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006900 if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006901 return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
6902 return SourceLocation();
6903}
6904
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006905struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
6906 Sema &S;
6907 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006908
6909 bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
6910 const OverloadCandidate *R) {
John McCall982adb52010-01-16 03:50:16 +00006911 // Fast-path this check.
6912 if (L == R) return false;
6913
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006914 // Order first by viability.
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006915 if (L->Viable) {
6916 if (!R->Viable) return true;
6917
6918 // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
6919 // candidates. Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
6920 // that could exploit it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006921 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
6922 if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00006923 } else if (R->Viable)
6924 return false;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006925
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006926 assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006927
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006928 // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
6929 if (!L->Viable) {
6930 // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
6931 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6932 L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6933 return false;
6934 if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
6935 R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
6936 return true;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006937
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006938 // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
6939 // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
6940 if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
6941 if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6942 return true;
6943
6944 // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
6945 // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
6946 assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
6947
6948 int leftBetter = 0;
John McCall21b57fa2010-02-25 10:46:05 +00006949 unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
6950 for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00006951 switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6952 L->Conversions[I],
6953 R->Conversions[I])) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006954 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6955 leftBetter++;
6956 break;
6957
6958 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6959 leftBetter--;
6960 break;
6961
6962 case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6963 break;
6964 }
6965 }
6966 if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
6967 if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
6968
6969 } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
6970 return false;
6971
John McCall3712d9e2010-01-15 23:32:50 +00006972 // TODO: others?
6973 }
6974
6975 // Sort everything else by location.
6976 SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
6977 SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
6978
6979 // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
6980 if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
6981 if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
6982
6983 return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00006984 }
6985};
6986
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006987/// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
6988/// computes up to the first
6989void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
6990 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
6991 assert(!Cand->Viable);
6992
6993 // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
6994 if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
6995
6996 // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00006997 unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00006998 unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
6999 while (true) {
7000 assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7001 ConvIdx++;
7002 if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad())
7003 break;
7004 }
7005
7006 if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7007 return;
7008
John McCall65eb8792010-02-25 01:37:24 +00007009 assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7010 "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7011
Douglas Gregoradc7a702010-04-16 17:45:54 +00007012 // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007013 // operation somehow.
7014 bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007015
7016 const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7017 unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7018
7019 if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7020 QualType ConvType
7021 = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7022 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7023 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7024 Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7025 ArgIdx--;
7026 } else if (Cand->Function) {
7027 Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7028 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7029 !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7030 ArgIdx--;
7031 } else {
7032 // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7033 assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7034 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7035 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007036 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7037 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007038 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007039 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007040 return;
7041 }
7042
7043 // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7044 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7045 for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
7046 if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto)
7047 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007048 = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007049 SuppressUserConversions,
Douglas Gregorcb13cfc2010-04-16 17:51:22 +00007050 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007051 else
7052 Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7053 }
7054}
7055
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007056} // end anonymous namespace
7057
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007058/// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7059/// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007060/// set.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007061void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7062 OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7063 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7064 const char *Opc,
7065 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007066 // Sort the candidates by viability and position. Sorting directly would
7067 // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
7068 llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007069 if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7070 for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007071 if (Cand->Viable)
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007072 Cands.push_back(Cand);
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007073 else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007074 CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007075 if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7076 Cands.push_back(Cand);
7077 // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate. We do not, in general,
7078 // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
John McCallfe796dd2010-01-23 05:17:32 +00007079 }
7080 }
7081
John McCallad2587a2010-01-12 00:48:53 +00007082 std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007083 CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007084
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007085 bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007086
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007087 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007088 const Diagnostic::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007089 unsigned CandsShown = 0;
John McCall12f97bc2010-01-08 04:41:39 +00007090 for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7091 OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
Douglas Gregor4fc308b2008-11-21 02:54:28 +00007092
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007093 // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7094 // the user with. FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7095 // candidate list.
7096 if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Diagnostic::Ovl_Best) {
7097 break;
7098 }
7099 ++CandsShown;
7100
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007101 if (Cand->Function)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007102 NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007103 else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007104 NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007105 else {
7106 assert(Cand->Viable &&
7107 "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007108 // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7109 // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7110 // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7111 //
7112 // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7113 // different ambiguities, though.
7114 if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007115 NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007116 ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7117 }
John McCalld3224162010-01-08 00:58:21 +00007118
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00007119 // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007120 NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +00007121 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007122 }
Jeffrey Yasskin2b99c6f2010-06-11 05:57:47 +00007123
7124 if (I != E)
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007125 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00007126}
7127
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007128// [PossiblyAFunctionType] --> [Return]
7129// NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7130// R (A) --> R(A)
7131// R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7132// R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7133// R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7134QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7135 QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7136 if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7137 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7138 Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7139 else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7140 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7141 Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007142 else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007143 PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7144 Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7145 Ret =
7146 Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7147 return Ret;
7148}
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007149
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007150// A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7151// - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7152class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7153{
7154 Sema& S;
7155 Expr* SourceExpr;
7156 const QualType& TargetType;
7157 QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7158
7159 bool Complain;
7160 //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7161 ASTContext& Context;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007162
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007163 bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7164 bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007165
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007166 OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7167 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7168 TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007169 llvm::SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007170
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007171public:
7172 AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7173 const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7174 : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7175 Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7176 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7177 !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7178 FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7179 OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7180 OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7181 {
7182 ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7183
7184 if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7185 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7186 DeclAccessPair dap;
7187 if( FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7188 OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
Chandler Carruthffce2452011-03-29 08:08:18 +00007189
7190 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7191 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7192 // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7193 // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7194 // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7195 TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7196
7197 // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7198 // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7199 if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7200 return;
7201 }
7202 }
7203
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007204 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7205 }
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007206 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007207 return;
Douglas Gregor9b146582009-07-08 20:55:45 +00007208 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007209
7210 if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7211 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007212
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007213 if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7214 // C++ [over.over]p4:
7215 // If more than one function is selected, [...]
7216 if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7217 if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7218 EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7219 else
7220 EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7221 }
7222 }
7223 }
7224
7225private:
7226 bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7227 return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7228 }
7229
7230 // [ToType] [Return]
7231
7232 // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7233 // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7234 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7235 void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7236 TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7237 }
7238
7239 // return true if any matching specializations were found
7240 bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7241 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7242 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7243 = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7244 // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7245 // static when converting to member pointer.
7246 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7247 return false;
7248 }
7249 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7250 return false;
7251
7252 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7253 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7254 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7255 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7256 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7257 // overloaded functions considered.
7258 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7259 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7260 if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7261 = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7262 &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7263 TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7264 Info)) {
7265 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7266 (void)Result;
7267 return false;
7268 }
7269
7270 // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
7271 // This function template specicalization works.
7272 Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
7273 assert(TargetFunctionType
7274 == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
7275 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
7276 return true;
7277 }
7278
7279 bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
7280 const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007281 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00007282 // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
7283 // when converting to member pointer.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007284 if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7285 return false;
7286 }
7287 else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7288 return false;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007289
Chandler Carruthc25c6ee2009-12-29 06:17:27 +00007290 if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007291 QualType ResultTy;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007292 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
7293 FunDecl->getType()) ||
7294 IsNoReturnConversion(Context, FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
Douglas Gregor40cb9ad2009-12-09 00:47:37 +00007295 ResultTy)) {
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007296 Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
7297 cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007298 FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007299 return true;
Douglas Gregorb257e4f2009-07-08 23:33:52 +00007300 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007301 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007302
7303 return false;
7304 }
7305
7306 bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
7307 bool Ret = false;
7308
7309 // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
7310 // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
7311 if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7312 return false;
7313
7314 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7315 E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
7316 I != E; ++I) {
7317 // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
7318 NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
7319
7320 // C++ [over.over]p3:
7321 // Non-member functions and static member functions match
7322 // targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
7323 // Nonstatic member functions match targets of
7324 // type "pointer-to-member-function."
7325 // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
7326 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7327 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
7328 if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
7329 Ret = true;
7330 }
7331 // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
7332 else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
7333 AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
7334 Ret = true;
7335 }
7336 assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
7337 return Ret;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007338 }
7339
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007340 void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00007341 // [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
7342 // eliminated if the set contains a second function template
7343 // specialization whose function template is more specialized
7344 // than the function template of F1 according to the partial
7345 // ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
7346
7347 // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
7348 // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
7349 // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
7350 // best function template (if it exists).
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007351
7352 UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
7353 for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
7354 MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007355
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007356 UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007357 S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
7358 TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
7359 S.PDiag(),
7360 S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7361 << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
7362 S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
7363 << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
7364 Complain);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007365
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007366 if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
7367 // Make it the first and only element
7368 Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
7369 Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
7370 Matches.resize(1);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007371 }
7372 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007373
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007374 void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
7375 // [...] any function template specializations in the set are
7376 // eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
7377 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
7378 if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
7379 ++I;
7380 else {
7381 Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
7382 Matches.set_size(N);
7383 }
7384 }
7385 }
7386
7387public:
7388 void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
7389 assert(Matches.empty());
7390 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
7391 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
7392 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7393 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7394 }
7395
7396 bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7397 return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
7398 !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
7399 }
7400
7401 void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
7402 // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
7403 // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
7404 // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
7405 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
7406 << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7407 }
7408
7409 void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
7410 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
7411 << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
7412 }
7413
7414 void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
7415 assert(Matches.size() > 1);
7416 S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7417 << OvlExpr->getName()
7418 << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
7419 S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7420 }
7421
7422 int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
7423
7424 FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
7425 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7426 return Matches[0].second;
7427 }
7428
7429 const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
7430 if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
7431 return &Matches[0].first;
7432 }
7433};
7434
7435/// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
7436/// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
7437/// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
7438/// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
7439///
7440/// @code
7441/// int f(double);
7442/// int f(int);
7443///
7444/// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
7445/// @endcode
7446///
7447/// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
7448/// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
7449/// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
7450FunctionDecl *
7451Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
7452 bool Complain,
7453 DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
7454
7455 assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7456
7457 AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
7458 int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
7459 FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
7460 if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
7461 if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
7462 Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
7463 else
7464 Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
7465 }
7466 else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
7467 Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
7468 else if (NumMatches == 1) {
7469 Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
7470 assert(Fn);
7471 FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
7472 MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
Douglas Gregor5bb5e4a2010-10-12 23:32:35 +00007473 if (Complain)
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007474 CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
Sebastian Redldf4b80e2009-10-17 21:12:09 +00007475 }
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007476
7477 return Fn;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00007478}
7479
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007480/// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007481/// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
7482///
7483/// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
7484/// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007485/// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007486/// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007487FunctionDecl *Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Expr *From,
7488 bool Complain,
7489 DeclAccessPair* FoundResult) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007490 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7491 // [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
7492 // overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007493 // C++ [over.over]p1:
7494 // [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
7495 // operator.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007496 if (From->getType() != Context.OverloadTy)
7497 return 0;
7498
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00007499 OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = OverloadExpr::find(From).Expression;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007500
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007501 // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007502 if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007503 return 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007504
7505 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
7506 OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007507
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007508 // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
7509 // whose type matches exactly.
7510 FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00007511 for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
7512 E = OvlExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007513 // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
7514 // [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007515 // where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
7516 // specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
7517 // identifies a single function template specialization, then the
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007518 // template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
Douglas Gregoreebe7212010-07-14 23:20:53 +00007519 FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
7520 = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007521
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007522 // C++ [over.over]p2:
7523 // If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7524 // done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7525 // resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7526 // function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7527 // overloaded functions considered.
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007528 FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007529 TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007530 if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7531 = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7532 Specialization, Info)) {
7533 // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7534 (void)Result;
7535 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007536 }
7537
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007538 // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007539 if (Matched) {
7540 if (FoundResult)
7541 *FoundResult = DeclAccessPair();
7542
7543 if (Complain) {
7544 Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
7545 << OvlExpr->getName();
7546 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
7547 }
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007548 return 0;
Douglas Gregorb491ed32011-02-19 21:32:49 +00007549 }
7550
7551 if ((Matched = Specialization) && FoundResult)
7552 *FoundResult = I.getPair();
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007553 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007554
Douglas Gregor8364e6b2009-12-21 23:17:24 +00007555 return Matched;
7556}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007557
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007558
7559
7560
7561// Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that
7562// can be resolved because it identifies a single function
7563// template specialization
7564// Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
7565ExprResult Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7566 Expr *SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion, bool Complain,
7567 const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
7568 QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
7569 unsigned DiagIDForComplaining ) {
7570
7571 assert(SrcExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
7572
7573 DeclAccessPair Found;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007574 ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007575 if (FunctionDecl* Fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7576 SrcExpr, false, // false -> Complain
7577 &Found)) {
7578 if (!DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, SrcExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
7579 // mark the expression as resolved to Fn
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007580 SingleFunctionExpression = Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr,
7581 Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007582 if (DoFunctionPointerConverion)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007583 SingleFunctionExpression =
7584 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007585 }
7586 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007587 if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007588 if (Complain) {
7589 OverloadExpr* oe = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression;
7590 Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
7591 << oe->getName() << DestTypeForComplaining << OpRangeForComplaining
7592 << oe->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
7593 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr);
7594 }
7595 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007596 }
Douglas Gregor89f3cd52011-03-16 19:16:25 +00007597
Douglas Gregor1beec452011-03-12 01:48:56 +00007598 return SingleFunctionExpression;
7599}
7600
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007601/// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
7602static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007603 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007604 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007605 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7606 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7607 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007608 NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007609 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
7610 Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
7611
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007612 if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00007613 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && "Explicit template arguments?");
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007614 S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorb05275a2010-04-16 17:41:49 +00007615 false, PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007616 return;
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007617 }
7618
7619 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
7620 = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007621 S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
7622 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007623 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007624 return;
7625 }
7626
7627 assert(false && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
7628
7629 // do nothing?
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007630}
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007631
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007632/// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
7633/// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007634void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007635 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7636 OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7637 bool PartialOverloading) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007638
7639#ifndef NDEBUG
7640 // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
7641 // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007642 //
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007643 // Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
7644 // and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
7645 // lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
7646 //
7647 // -- a declaration of a class member, or
7648 //
7649 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007650 // using-declaration, or
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007651 //
7652 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
7653 // template
7654 //
7655 // then Y is empty.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007656
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007657 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7658 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7659 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7660 assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
7661 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
7662 !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
7663 assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007664 }
7665 }
7666#endif
7667
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007668 // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
7669 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
Douglas Gregor739b107a2011-03-03 02:41:12 +00007670 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007671 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7672 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7673 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7674 }
7675
7676 for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
7677 E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007678 AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007679 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007680 PartialOverloading);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007681
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007682 if (ULE->requiresADL())
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007683 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
7684 Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007685 ExplicitTemplateArgs,
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007686 CandidateSet,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007687 PartialOverloading);
Douglas Gregorcabea402009-09-22 15:41:20 +00007688}
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007689
7690/// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
7691///
7692/// Returns true if new candidates were found.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007693static ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007694BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007695 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
7696 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7697 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007698 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007699
7700 CXXScopeSpec SS;
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007701 SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007702
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007703 TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
7704 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
7705 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7706 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
7707 ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
7708 }
7709
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007710 LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
7711 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00007712 if (SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression))
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007713 return ExprError();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007714
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007715 assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
7716
7717 // Build an implicit member call if appropriate. Just drop the
7718 // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007719 ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007720 if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007721 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
7722 ExplicitTemplateArgs);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007723 else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7724 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
7725 else
7726 NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
7727
7728 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00007729 return ExprError();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007730
7731 // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
7732 // an expression with non-empty lookup results, which should never
7733 // end up here.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007734 return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007735 MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007736}
Douglas Gregor4038cf42010-06-08 17:35:15 +00007737
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007738/// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00007739/// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
7740/// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
7741/// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
7742/// the function declaration produced by overload
Douglas Gregora60a6912008-11-26 06:01:48 +00007743/// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007744/// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007745ExprResult
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007746Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007747 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
7748 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007749 SourceLocation RParenLoc,
7750 Expr *ExecConfig) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007751#ifndef NDEBUG
7752 if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
7753 // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
7754 assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
7755
7756 // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
7757 // Verify that this was correctly set up.
7758 FunctionDecl *F;
7759 if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
7760 (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
7761 F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
7762 assert(0 && "performing ADL for builtin");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007763
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007764 // We don't perform ADL in C.
7765 assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
7766 }
7767#endif
7768
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007769 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00007770
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007771 // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
7772 // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
7773 AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007774
7775 // If we found nothing, try to recover.
7776 // AddRecoveryCallCandidates diagnoses the error itself, so we just
7777 // bailout out if it fails.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007778 if (CandidateSet.empty())
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00007779 return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00007780 RParenLoc);
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00007781
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007782 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007783 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007784 case OR_Success: {
7785 FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007786 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007787 CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00007788 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl? FDecl : Best->FoundDecl.getDecl(),
7789 ULE->getNameLoc());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00007790 Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
Peter Collingbourne41f85462011-02-09 21:07:24 +00007791 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
7792 ExecConfig);
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007793 }
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007794
7795 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
Chris Lattner45d9d602009-02-17 07:29:20 +00007796 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007797 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007798 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007799 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007800 break;
7801
7802 case OR_Ambiguous:
7803 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007804 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007805 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007806 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007807
7808 case OR_Deleted:
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007809 {
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007810 Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
7811 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
7812 << ULE->getName()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00007813 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00007814 << Fn->getSourceRange();
Fariborz Jahanianbff158d2011-02-25 18:38:59 +00007815 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
7816 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00007817 break;
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007818 }
7819
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00007820 // Overload resolution failed.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00007821 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor99dcbff2008-11-26 05:54:23 +00007822}
7823
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007824static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00007825 return Functions.size() > 1 ||
7826 (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
7827}
7828
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007829/// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
7830/// operator.
7831///
7832/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
7833///
7834/// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
7835/// operator.
7836///
7837/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
7838/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
7839/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
7840/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
7841/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
7842/// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
7843///
7844/// \param input The input argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007845ExprResult
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007846Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
7847 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007848 Expr *Input) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007849 UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007850
7851 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
7852 assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
7853 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00007854 // TODO: provide better source location info.
7855 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007856
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007857 if (Input->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
7858 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Input);
7859 if (Result.isInvalid())
7860 return ExprError();
7861 Input = Result.take();
7862 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00007863
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007864 Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
7865 unsigned NumArgs = 1;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007866
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007867 // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
7868 // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
7869 // post-decrement.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007870 if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007871 llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00007872 Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
7873 SourceLocation());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007874 NumArgs = 2;
7875 }
7876
7877 if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007878 if (Fns.empty())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007879 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007880 Opc,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007881 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007882 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor630dec52010-06-17 15:46:20 +00007883 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007884
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00007885 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00007886 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00007887 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007888 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00007889 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
7890 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007891 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00007892 &Args[0], NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007893 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007894 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007895 OpLoc));
7896 }
7897
7898 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00007899 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007900
7901 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007902 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007903
7904 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
7905 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
7906
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007907 // Add candidates from ADL.
7908 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
Douglas Gregor6ec89d42010-02-05 05:15:43 +00007909 Args, NumArgs,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007910 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
7911 CandidateSet);
7912
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007913 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00007914 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007915
7916 // Perform overload resolution.
7917 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00007918 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007919 case OR_Success: {
7920 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
7921 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007922
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007923 if (FnDecl) {
7924 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
7925 // operator.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007926
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00007927 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
7928
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007929 // Convert the arguments.
7930 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00007931 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00007932
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007933 ExprResult InputRes =
7934 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
7935 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
7936 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007937 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007938 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007939 } else {
7940 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007941 ExprResult InputInit
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007942 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00007943 Context,
Douglas Gregor8d48e9a2009-12-23 00:02:00 +00007944 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007945 SourceLocation(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007946 Input);
Douglas Gregore6600372009-12-23 17:40:29 +00007947 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007948 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007949 Input = InputInit.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007950 }
7951
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007952 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
7953
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007954 // Determine the result type.
7955 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
7956 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
7957 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007958
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007959 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007960 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl);
7961 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
7962 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007963
Eli Friedman030eee42009-11-18 03:58:17 +00007964 Args[0] = Input;
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007965 CallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007966 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00007967 Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00007968
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00007969 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssonf64a3da2009-10-13 21:19:37 +00007970 FnDecl))
7971 return ExprError();
7972
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007973 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007974 } else {
7975 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
7976 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
7977 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007978 ExprResult InputRes =
7979 PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
7980 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
7981 if (InputRes.isInvalid())
7982 return ExprError();
7983 Input = InputRes.take();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007984 break;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007985 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00007986 }
7987
7988 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
7989 // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
7990 // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
7991 break;
7992
7993 case OR_Ambiguous:
7994 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
7995 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
7996 << Input->getType()
7997 << Input->getSourceRange();
7998 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates,
7999 Args, NumArgs,
8000 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8001 return ExprError();
8002
8003 case OR_Deleted:
8004 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8005 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8006 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8007 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8008 << Input->getSourceRange();
8009 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8010 return ExprError();
8011 }
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008012
8013 // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8014 // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8015 // build a built-in operation.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008016 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008017}
8018
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008019/// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8020/// operator.
8021///
8022/// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8023///
8024/// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8025/// operator.
8026///
8027/// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8028/// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8029/// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8030/// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8031/// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8032/// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8033///
8034/// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8035/// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008036ExprResult
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008037Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008038 unsigned OpcIn,
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008039 const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008040 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008041 Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008042 LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008043
8044 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8045 OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8046 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8047
8048 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8049 // expression.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008050 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008051 if (Fns.empty()) {
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008052 // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008053 // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008054 if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008055 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008056 Context.DependentTy,
8057 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8058 OpLoc));
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008059
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008060 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8061 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008062 VK_LValue,
8063 OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00008064 Context.DependentTy,
8065 Context.DependentTy,
8066 OpLoc));
8067 }
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008068
8069 // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008070 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008071 // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8072 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008073 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008074 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8075 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8076 /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008077 Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008078 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008079 Args, 2,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008080 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008081 VK_RValue,
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008082 OpLoc));
8083 }
8084
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008085 // Always do property rvalue conversions on the RHS.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008086 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8087 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8088 if (Result.isInvalid())
8089 return ExprError();
8090 Args[1] = Result.take();
8091 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008092
8093 // The LHS is more complicated.
8094 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8095
8096 // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
8097 // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
8098 if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
8099 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
8100
8101 // Is the property "logically" settable?
8102 bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
8103 PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
8104
8105 // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
8106 // unless it isn't. Thoughts in case we ever really care:
8107 // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
8108 // load and hope.
8109 // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
8110 // we really should use the primitive.
8111 // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
8112 // on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type; if it works
8113 // out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
8114 // on the property, and otherwise just error.
8115 if (Settable)
8116 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8117 }
8118
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008119 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8120 if (Result.isInvalid())
8121 return ExprError();
8122 Args[0] = Result.take();
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008123 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008124
Sebastian Redl6a96bf72009-11-18 23:10:33 +00008125 // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
8126 // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
8127 // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
8128 // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
8129 // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
8130 // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008131 if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008132 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008133
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008134 // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
8135 // create a built-in binary operator.
8136 if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
8137 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
8138
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00008139 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008140 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008141
8142 // Add the candidates from the given function set.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008143 AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008144
8145 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8146 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8147
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00008148 // Add candidates from ADL.
8149 AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8150 Args, 2,
8151 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8152 CandidateSet);
8153
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008154 // Add builtin operator candidates.
Douglas Gregorc02cfe22009-10-21 23:19:44 +00008155 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008156
8157 // Perform overload resolution.
8158 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008159 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00008160 case OR_Success: {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008161 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8162 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8163
8164 if (FnDecl) {
8165 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8166 // operator.
8167
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008168 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8169
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008170 // Convert the arguments.
8171 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008172 // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008173 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCallb3a44002010-01-28 01:42:12 +00008174
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008175 ExprResult Arg1 =
8176 PerformCopyInitialization(
8177 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8178 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8179 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008180 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008181 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008182
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008183 ExprResult Arg0 =
8184 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8185 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8186 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008187 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008188 Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008189 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008190 } else {
8191 // Convert the arguments.
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008192 ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
8193 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8194 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8195 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008196 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008197 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008198
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008199 ExprResult Arg1 =
8200 PerformCopyInitialization(
8201 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
8202 FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
8203 SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
Douglas Gregor0a70c4d2009-12-22 21:44:34 +00008204 if (Arg1.isInvalid())
8205 return ExprError();
8206 Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
8207 Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008208 }
8209
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008210 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8211
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008212 // Determine the result type.
8213 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8214 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8215 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008216
8217 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008218 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, OpLoc);
8219 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8220 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008221
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008222 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008223 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008224 Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008225
8226 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00008227 FnDecl))
8228 return ExprError();
8229
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008230 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008231 } else {
8232 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8233 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8234 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008235 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8236 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8237 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8238 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008239 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008240 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008241
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008242 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8243 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8244 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8245 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8246 return ExprError();
8247 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008248 break;
8249 }
8250 }
8251
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008252 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8253 // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
8254 // If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
8255 // viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
8256 // built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008257 if (Opc == BO_Comma)
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008258 break;
8259
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008260 // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
8261 // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
8262 // no overloaded assignment operator found
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008263 ExprResult Result = ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008264 if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008265 Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008266 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
8267 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008268 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008269 } else {
8270 // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
8271 // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
8272 Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Sebastian Redl027de2a2009-05-21 11:50:50 +00008273 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008274 assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008275 "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
8276 if (Result.isInvalid())
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008277 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8278 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008279 return move(Result);
8280 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008281
8282 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008283 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008284 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008285 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008286 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008287 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8288 BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008289 return ExprError();
8290
8291 case OR_Deleted:
8292 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8293 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8294 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008295 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008296 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008297 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008298 return ExprError();
John McCall0d1da222010-01-12 00:44:57 +00008299 }
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008300
Douglas Gregor66950a32009-09-30 21:46:01 +00008301 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
Douglas Gregore9899d92009-08-26 17:08:25 +00008302 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00008303}
8304
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008305ExprResult
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008306Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
8307 SourceLocation RLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008308 Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
8309 Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008310 DeclarationName OpName =
8311 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
8312
8313 // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8314 // expression.
8315 if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8316
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008317 CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00008318 // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
8319 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
8320 OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008321 UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
Douglas Gregora6e053e2010-12-15 01:34:56 +00008322 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00008323 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00008324 /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
8325 UnresolvedSetIterator(),
8326 UnresolvedSetIterator());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00008327 // Can't add any actual overloads yet
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008328
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008329 return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
8330 Args, 2,
8331 Context.DependentTy,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008332 VK_RValue,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008333 RLoc));
8334 }
8335
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008336 if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8337 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
8338 if (Result.isInvalid())
8339 return ExprError();
8340 Args[0] = Result.take();
8341 }
8342 if (Args[1]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8343 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[1]);
8344 if (Result.isInvalid())
8345 return ExprError();
8346 Args[1] = Result.take();
8347 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008348
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008349 // Build an empty overload set.
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008350 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008351
8352 // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
8353
8354 // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8355 AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8356
8357 // Add builtin operator candidates.
8358 AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
8359
8360 // Perform overload resolution.
8361 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008362 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008363 case OR_Success: {
8364 // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8365 FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8366
8367 if (FnDecl) {
8368 // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8369 // operator.
8370
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008371 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
8372
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008373 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008374 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00008375
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008376 // Convert the arguments.
8377 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008378 ExprResult Arg0 =
8379 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
8380 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8381 if (Arg0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008382 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008383 Args[0] = Arg0.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008384
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008385 // Convert the arguments.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008386 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008387 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008388 Context,
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008389 FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008390 SourceLocation(),
Anders Carlssona68e51e2010-01-29 18:37:50 +00008391 Owned(Args[1]));
8392 if (InputInit.isInvalid())
8393 return ExprError();
8394
8395 Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
8396
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008397 // Determine the result type
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008398 QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8399 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8400 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008401
8402 // Build the actual expression node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008403 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, LLoc);
8404 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8405 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008406
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008407 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
8408 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008409 FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008410 ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008411
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008412 if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008413 FnDecl))
8414 return ExprError();
8415
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008416 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008417 } else {
8418 // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8419 // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8420 // operator node.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008421 ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
8422 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8423 Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8424 if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008425 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008426 Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
8427
8428 ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
8429 PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
8430 Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
8431 if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
8432 return ExprError();
8433 Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008434
8435 break;
8436 }
8437 }
8438
8439 case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008440 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8441 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8442 << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
8443 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
8444 else
8445 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
8446 << Args[0]->getType()
8447 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008448 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8449 "[]", LLoc);
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008450 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008451 }
8452
8453 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008454 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008455 << "[]"
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008456 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
8457 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008458 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
8459 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008460 return ExprError();
8461
8462 case OR_Deleted:
8463 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8464 << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008465 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008466 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008467 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
8468 "[]", LLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008469 return ExprError();
8470 }
8471
8472 // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008473 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00008474}
8475
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008476/// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
8477/// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
8478/// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
8479/// arguments to the function call (not including the object
8480/// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
8481/// expression refers to a member function or an overloaded member
8482/// function.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008483ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008484Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
8485 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008486 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008487 // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
8488 // argument and the member function we're referring to.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008489 Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008490
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008491 MemberExpr *MemExpr;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008492 CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
John McCall3a65ef42010-04-08 00:13:37 +00008493 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008494 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008495 if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
8496 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008497 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008498 FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008499 Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008500 } else {
8501 UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00008502 Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008503
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008504 QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008505 Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
8506 = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
8507 : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008508
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008509 // Add overload candidates
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008510 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008511
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008512 // FIXME: avoid copy.
8513 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
8514 if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8515 UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
8516 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
8517 }
8518
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008519 for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
8520 E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8521
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008522 NamedDecl *Func = *I;
8523 CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
8524 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
8525 Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
8526
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008527
Francois Pichet64225792011-01-18 05:04:39 +00008528 // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
8529 if (getLangOptions().Microsoft && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
8530 AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
8531 CandidateSet);
8532 } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008533 // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
8534 // non-template member function.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008535 if (TemplateArgs)
Douglas Gregord3319842009-10-24 04:59:53 +00008536 continue;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008537
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008538 AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008539 ObjectClassification,
8540 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008541 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008542 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008543 AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008544 I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008545 ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008546 Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008547 /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00008548 }
Douglas Gregor5ed5ae42009-08-21 18:42:58 +00008549 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008550
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008551 DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
8552
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008553 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008554 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
Nick Lewycky9331ed82010-11-20 01:29:55 +00008555 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008556 case OR_Success:
8557 Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008558 MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008559 FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008560 CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008561 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008562 break;
8563
8564 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008565 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008566 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008567 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008568 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008569 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008570 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008571
8572 case OR_Ambiguous:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008573 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
Douglas Gregor97628d62009-08-21 00:16:32 +00008574 << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008575 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008576 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008577 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008578
8579 case OR_Deleted:
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008580 Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008581 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008582 << DeclName
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008583 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008584 << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008585 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008586 // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008587 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008588 }
8589
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008590 MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008591
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008592 // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
8593 // non-member call based on that function.
8594 if (Method->isStatic()) {
8595 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
8596 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
8597 }
8598
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00008599 MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008600 }
8601
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008602 QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
8603 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
8604 ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8605
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008606 assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008607 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008608 new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008609 ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008610
Anders Carlssonc4859ba2009-10-10 00:06:20 +00008611 // Check for a valid return type.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008612 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008613 TheCall, Method))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008614 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008615
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008616 // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00008617 // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
8618 // it was done at lookup.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008619 if (!Method->isStatic()) {
8620 ExprResult ObjectArg =
8621 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
8622 FoundDecl, Method);
8623 if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
8624 return ExprError();
8625 MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
8626 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008627
8628 // Convert the rest of the arguments
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008629 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8630 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008631 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008632 RParenLoc))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008633 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008634
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008635 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00008636 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8c84c202009-08-16 03:42:12 +00008637
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008638 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00008639}
8640
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008641/// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
8642/// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
8643/// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
8644/// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
John McCallfaf5fb42010-08-26 23:41:50 +00008645ExprResult
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008646Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
Douglas Gregorb0846b02008-12-06 00:22:45 +00008647 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008648 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008649 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008650 ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
8651 if (Object.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8652 Object = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Object.take());
8653 if (Object.isInvalid())
8654 return ExprError();
8655 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008656
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008657 assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
8658 const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008659
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008660 // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
8661 // If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
Eli Friedman44b83ee2009-08-05 19:21:58 +00008662 // evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008663 // candidate functions includes at least the function call
8664 // operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
8665 // ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
8666 // (E).operator().
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008667 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91f84212008-12-11 16:49:14 +00008668 DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008669
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008670 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00008671 PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008672 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008673 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008674
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008675 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8676 LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
8677 R.suppressDiagnostics();
8678
Douglas Gregorc473cbb2009-11-15 07:48:03 +00008679 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008680 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008681 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
8682 Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
John McCallf0f1cf02009-11-17 07:50:12 +00008683 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
Douglas Gregor358e7742009-11-07 17:23:56 +00008684 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008685
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008686 // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
8687 // In addition, for each conversion function declared in T of the
8688 // form
8689 //
8690 // operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
8691 //
8692 // where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
8693 // greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
Douglas Gregorf49fdf82008-11-20 13:33:37 +00008694 // denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
8695 // R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
8696 // (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
8697 // of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008698 // is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
8699 // surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
8700 // functions for each conversion function declared in an
8701 // accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
8702 // within T by another intervening declaration.
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008703 const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
Douglas Gregor21591822010-01-11 19:36:35 +00008704 = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
John McCallad371252010-01-20 00:46:10 +00008705 for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008706 E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008707 NamedDecl *D = *I;
8708 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
8709 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8710 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008711
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008712 // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
8713 // surrogates.
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008714 if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008715 continue;
Douglas Gregor05155d82009-08-21 23:19:43 +00008716
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008717 CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00008718
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008719 // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
8720 // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
8721 QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
8722 if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
8723 ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008724
Douglas Gregor74ba25c2009-10-21 06:18:39 +00008725 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008726 AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008727 Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008728 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008729
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008730 // Perform overload resolution.
8731 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008732 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008733 Best)) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008734 case OR_Success:
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008735 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
8736 // below.
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008737 break;
8738
8739 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008740 if (CandidateSet.empty())
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008741 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
8742 << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
8743 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008744 else
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008745 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall02374852010-01-07 02:04:15 +00008746 diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008747 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008748 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008749 break;
8750
8751 case OR_Ambiguous:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008752 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008753 diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008754 << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008755 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008756 break;
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008757
8758 case OR_Deleted:
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008759 Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008760 diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
8761 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008762 << Object.get()->getType()
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008763 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008764 << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008765 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008766 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008767 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008768
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008769 if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008770 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008771
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008772 if (Best->Function == 0) {
8773 // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
8774 // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008775 CXXConversionDecl *Conv
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008776 = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
8777 Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
8778
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008779 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008780 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008781
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008782 // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
8783 // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
8784 // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008785
Fariborz Jahanian774cf792009-09-28 18:35:46 +00008786 // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
Fariborz Jahanian78cfcb52009-09-28 23:23:40 +00008787 // and then call it.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008788 ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl, Conv);
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008789 if (Call.isInvalid())
8790 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008791
Douglas Gregor668443e2011-01-20 00:18:04 +00008792 return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00008793 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008794 }
8795
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008796 MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008797 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008798 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
John McCall49ec2e62010-01-28 01:54:34 +00008799
Douglas Gregorab7897a2008-11-19 22:57:39 +00008800 // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
8801 // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
8802 // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
8803 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008804 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
8805 Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008806
8807 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
8808 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
8809
8810 // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
8811 // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
8812 // list).
8813 Expr **MethodArgs;
8814 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
8815 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8816 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
8817 } else {
8818 MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
8819 }
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008820 MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008821 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
8822 MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008823
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008824 ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
8825 if (NewFn.isInvalid())
8826 return true;
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008827
8828 // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
8829 // owned.
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008830 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
8831 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8832 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8833
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008834 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008835 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008836 MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00008837 ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008838 delete [] MethodArgs;
8839
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008840 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlsson3d5829c2009-10-13 21:49:31 +00008841 Method))
8842 return true;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008843
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008844 // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
8845 // slots in the call for them.
8846 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00008847 TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008848 else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
8849 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
8850
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008851 bool IsError = false;
8852
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008853 // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008854 ExprResult ObjRes =
8855 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
8856 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8857 if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
8858 IsError = true;
8859 else
8860 Object = move(ObjRes);
8861 TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008862
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008863 // Check the argument types.
8864 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008865 Expr *Arg;
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008866 if (i < NumArgs) {
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008867 Arg = Args[i];
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008868
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008869 // Pass the argument.
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008870
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008871 ExprResult InputInit
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008872 = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00008873 Context,
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008874 Method->getParamDecl(i)),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008875 SourceLocation(), Arg);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008876
Anders Carlsson7c5fe482010-01-29 18:43:53 +00008877 IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
8878 Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008879 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008880 ExprResult DefArg
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008881 = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
8882 if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
8883 IsError = true;
8884 break;
8885 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00008886
Douglas Gregor1bc688d2009-11-09 19:27:57 +00008887 Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor02a0acd2009-01-13 05:10:00 +00008888 }
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008889
8890 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
8891 }
8892
8893 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
8894 if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
8895 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
8896 for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008897 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
8898 IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
8899 TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008900 }
8901 }
8902
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +00008903 if (IsError) return true;
8904
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008905 if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00008906 return true;
8907
John McCalle172be52010-08-24 06:09:16 +00008908 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregor91cea0a2008-11-19 21:05:33 +00008909}
8910
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008911/// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008912/// (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008913/// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008914ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00008915Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008916 assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
8917 "left-hand side must have class type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008918
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008919 if (Base->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
8920 ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Base);
8921 if (Result.isInvalid())
8922 return ExprError();
8923 Base = Result.take();
8924 }
John McCalle26a8722010-12-04 08:14:53 +00008925
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008926 SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
8927
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008928 // C++ [over.ref]p1:
8929 //
8930 // [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
8931 // for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
8932 // the operator is selected as the best match function by the
8933 // overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
Chandler Carruth8e543b32010-12-12 08:17:55 +00008934 DeclarationName OpName =
8935 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008936 OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00008937 const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008938
John McCallbc077cf2010-02-08 23:07:23 +00008939 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
Eli Friedman132e70b2009-11-18 01:28:03 +00008940 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
8941 << Base->getSourceRange()))
8942 return ExprError();
8943
John McCall27b18f82009-11-17 02:14:36 +00008944 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
8945 LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
8946 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Anders Carlsson78b54932009-09-10 23:18:36 +00008947
8948 for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008949 Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
Douglas Gregor02824322011-01-26 19:30:28 +00008950 AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
8951 0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
John McCall6e9f8f62009-12-03 04:06:58 +00008952 }
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008953
8954 // Perform overload resolution.
8955 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008956 switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008957 case OR_Success:
8958 // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
8959 break;
8960
8961 case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8962 if (CandidateSet.empty())
8963 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008964 << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008965 else
8966 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008967 << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008968 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008969 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008970
8971 case OR_Ambiguous:
Douglas Gregor052caec2010-11-13 20:06:38 +00008972 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8973 << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008974 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008975 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00008976
8977 case OR_Deleted:
8978 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8979 << Best->Function->isDeleted()
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008980 << "->"
Douglas Gregor20b2ebd2011-03-23 00:50:03 +00008981 << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
Fariborz Jahaniane6b127d2011-02-25 20:51:14 +00008982 << Base->getSourceRange();
John McCall5c32be02010-08-24 20:38:10 +00008983 CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008984 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008985 }
8986
Chandler Carruth30141632011-02-25 19:41:05 +00008987 MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008988 CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
John McCall4fa0d5f2010-05-06 18:15:07 +00008989 DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
John McCalla0296f72010-03-19 07:35:19 +00008990
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00008991 // Convert the object parameter.
8992 CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008993 ExprResult BaseResult =
8994 PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8995 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8996 if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00008997 return ExprError();
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00008998 Base = BaseResult.take();
Douglas Gregor9ecea262008-11-21 03:04:22 +00008999
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009000 // Build the operator call.
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009001 ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method);
9002 if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9003 return ExprError();
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009004
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009005 QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9006 ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9007 ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00009008 CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
John Wiegley01296292011-04-08 18:41:53 +00009009 new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009010 &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009011
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009012 if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
Anders Carlssone4f4b5e2009-10-13 22:43:21 +00009013 Method))
9014 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman2d9c47e2011-04-04 01:18:25 +00009015
9016 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Douglas Gregore0e79bd2008-11-20 16:27:02 +00009017}
9018
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009019/// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
9020/// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
9021/// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
9022/// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
Anders Carlssonfcb4ab42009-10-21 17:16:23 +00009023/// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00009024Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009025 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009026 if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009027 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
9028 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009029 if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009030 return PE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009031
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009032 return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009033 }
9034
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009035 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009036 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
9037 Found, Fn);
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009038 assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009039 SubExpr->getType()) &&
Douglas Gregor091f0422009-10-23 22:18:25 +00009040 "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009041 assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009042 if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009043 return ICE;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009044
9045 return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00009046 ICE->getCastKind(),
9047 SubExpr, 0,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00009048 ICE->getValueKind());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009049 }
9050
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009051 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009052 assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009053 "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009054 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
9055 if (Method->isStatic()) {
9056 // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
9057 // from non-member functions.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009058 } else {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009059 // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
9060 // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
9061 // or template.
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009062 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9063 Found, Fn);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009064 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009065 return UnOp;
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009066
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009067 assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
9068 && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
9069 assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
9070 && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
9071
9072 // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
9073 // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
9074 // appropriate pointer to member type.
9075 QualType ClassType
9076 = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
9077 QualType MemPtrType
9078 = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
9079
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009080 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
9081 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
9082 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
Douglas Gregor6f233ef2009-02-11 01:18:59 +00009083 }
9084 }
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009085 Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
9086 Found, Fn);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009087 if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009088 return UnOp;
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009089
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00009090 return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009091 Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009092 VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009093 UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009094 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009095
9096 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009097 // FIXME: avoid copy.
9098 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009099 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009100 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9101 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00009102 }
9103
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009104 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009105 ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009106 Fn,
9107 ULE->getNameLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009108 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009109 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009110 TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00009111 }
9112
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00009113 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009114 // FIXME: avoid copy.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009115 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9116 if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9117 MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9118 TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9119 }
John McCall6b51f282009-11-23 01:53:49 +00009120
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009121 Expr *Base;
9122
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009123 // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
9124 // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009125 if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
9126 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
9127 return DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009128 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009129 Fn,
9130 MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9131 Fn->getType(),
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009132 VK_LValue,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009133 TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009134 } else {
9135 SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
9136 if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
Douglas Gregor0da1d432011-02-28 20:01:57 +00009137 Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00009138 Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
9139 MemExpr->getBaseType(),
9140 /*isImplicit=*/true);
9141 }
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009142 } else
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009143 Base = MemExpr->getBase();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009144
9145 return MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009146 MemExpr->isArrow(),
Douglas Gregorea972d32011-02-28 21:54:11 +00009147 MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009148 Fn,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009149 Found,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00009150 MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00009151 TemplateArgs,
John McCall7decc9e2010-11-18 06:31:45 +00009152 Fn->getType(),
9153 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()
9154 ? VK_LValue : VK_RValue,
9155 OK_Ordinary);
Douglas Gregor51c538b2009-11-20 19:42:02 +00009156 }
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009157
John McCallc3007a22010-10-26 07:05:15 +00009158 llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
9159 return E;
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00009160}
9161
NAKAMURA Takumif9cbcc42011-01-27 07:10:08 +00009162ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00009163 DeclAccessPair Found,
9164 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00009165 return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
Douglas Gregor3e1e5272009-12-09 23:02:17 +00009166}
9167
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00009168} // end namespace clang